blob: 66ba72c0ff817e269abb91f514cd1077844d30f2 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau60612eb2011-09-10 23:43:11 +02007 2011/09/10
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
17 This document is formated with 80 columns per line, with even number of
18 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020050
514. Proxies
524.1. Proxy keywords matrix
534.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
54
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +0100555. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020056
576. HTTP header manipulation
58
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100597. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200607.1. Matching integers
617.2. Matching strings
627.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
637.4. Matching IPv4 addresses
647.5. Available matching criteria
657.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
667.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4
677.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
687.6. Pre-defined ACLs
697.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100707.8. Pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020071
728. Logging
738.1. Log levels
748.2. Log formats
758.2.1. Default log format
768.2.2. TCP log format
778.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100788.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200798.3. Advanced logging options
808.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
818.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
828.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
838.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
848.4. Timing events
858.5. Session state at disconnection
868.6. Non-printable characters
878.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
888.8. Capturing HTTP headers
898.9. Examples of logs
90
919. Statistics and monitoring
929.1. CSV format
939.2. Unix Socket commands
94
95
961. Quick reminder about HTTP
97----------------------------
98
99When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
100fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
101on almost anything found in the contents.
102
103However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
104formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
105correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
106
107
1081.1. The HTTP transaction model
109-------------------------------
110
111The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100112to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200113from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
114connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
115will involve a new connection :
116
117 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
118
119In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
120establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
121by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
122length.
123
124Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
125to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
126however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
127response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
128header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
129
130 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
131
132Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
133power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
134but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200135a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200136
137A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
138keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
139second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
140page :
141
142 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
143
144This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
145latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
146correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
147the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100148server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200150By default HAProxy operates in a tunnel-like mode with regards to persistent
151connections: for each connection it processes the first request and forwards
152everything else (including additional requests) to selected server. Once
153established, the connection is persisted both on the client and server
154sides. Use "option http-server-close" to preserve client persistent connections
155while handling every incoming request individually, dispatching them one after
156another to servers, in HTTP close mode. Use "option httpclose" to switch both
157sides to HTTP close mode. "option forceclose" and "option
158http-pretend-keepalive" help working around servers misbehaving in HTTP close
159mode.
160
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200161
1621.2. HTTP request
163-----------------
164
165First, let's consider this HTTP request :
166
167 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100168 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
170 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
171 3 User-agent: my small browser
172 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
173 5 Accept: image/png
174
175
1761.2.1. The Request line
177-----------------------
178
179Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
180
181 - a METHOD : GET
182 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
183 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
184
185All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
186which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
187followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
188is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
189desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
190the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
191
192The URI itself can have several forms :
193
194 - A "relative URI" :
195
196 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
197
198 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
199 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
200
201 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
202
203 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
204
205 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
206 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
207 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
208 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
209 must accept this form too.
210
211 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
212 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
213 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100214
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200215 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
216 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
217 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
218 other protocols too.
219
220In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
221mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
222on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
223It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
224specific to the language, framework or application in use.
225
226
2271.2.2. The request headers
228--------------------------
229
230The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
231beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
232an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
233Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
234values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
235encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
236the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
237define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
238
239Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
240their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
241"Connection:" header).
242
243The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
244that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
245is one valid form of empty line.
246
247Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
248headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
249about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
250application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
251
252Important note:
253 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
254 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
255 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
256 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
257
258
2591.3. HTTP response
260------------------
261
262An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
263messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
264
265 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100266 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200267 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
268 2 Content-length: 350
269 3 Content-Type: text/html
270
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200271As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
272codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
273response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100274continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
275the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
276following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
277sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
278(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
279correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
280such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
281state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
282over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
283if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
284information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200285
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200286
2871.3.1. The Response line
288------------------------
289
290Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
291
292 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
293 - a status code : 200
294 - a reason : OK
295
296The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200297 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200298 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
299 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
300 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
301 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
302
303Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100304"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200305found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
306messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
307or "Authentication Required".
308
309Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
310
311 Code When / reason
312 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
313 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
314 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
315 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
316 400 for an invalid or too large request
317 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
318 accessing the stats page)
319 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
320 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
321 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
322 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
323 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
324 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
325 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
326 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
327 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
328
329The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3304.2).
331
332
3331.3.2. The response headers
334---------------------------
335
336Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
337the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
338details.
339
340
3412. Configuring HAProxy
342----------------------
343
3442.1. Configuration file format
345------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200346
347HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
348
349 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
350 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
351 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
352 "frontend" and "backend".
353
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100354The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
355referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
356delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100357preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100358escaped by doubling them.
359
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200360
3612.2. Time format
362----------------
363
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100364Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100365values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
366otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
367numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
368for every keyword. Supported units are :
369
370 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
371 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
372 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
373 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
374 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
375 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
376
377
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003782.3. Examples
379-------------
380
381 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
382 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
383 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
384 global
385 daemon
386 maxconn 256
387
388 defaults
389 mode http
390 timeout connect 5000ms
391 timeout client 50000ms
392 timeout server 50000ms
393
394 frontend http-in
395 bind *:80
396 default_backend servers
397
398 backend servers
399 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
400
401
402 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
403 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
404 global
405 daemon
406 maxconn 256
407
408 defaults
409 mode http
410 timeout connect 5000ms
411 timeout client 50000ms
412 timeout server 50000ms
413
414 listen http-in
415 bind *:80
416 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
417
418
419Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
420
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100421 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200422
423
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004243. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200425--------------------
426
427Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
428are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
429of them have command-line equivalents.
430
431The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
432
433 * Process management and security
434 - chroot
435 - daemon
436 - gid
437 - group
438 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100439 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200440 - nbproc
441 - pidfile
442 - uid
443 - ulimit-n
444 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200445 - stats
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200446 - node
447 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100448 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100449
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200450 * Performance tuning
451 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200452 - maxconnrate
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100453 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200454 - noepoll
455 - nokqueue
456 - nopoll
457 - nosepoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100458 - nosplice
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200459 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200460 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200461 - tune.chksize
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200462 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100463 - tune.maxaccept
464 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200465 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200466 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100467 - tune.rcvbuf.client
468 - tune.rcvbuf.server
469 - tune.sndbuf.client
470 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100471
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200472 * Debugging
473 - debug
474 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200475
476
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004773.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200478------------------------------------
479
480chroot <jail dir>
481 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
482 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
483 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
484 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
485 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
486 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100487
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200488daemon
489 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
490 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
491 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
492
493gid <number>
494 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
495 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
496 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
497 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100498
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200499group <group name>
500 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
501 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100502
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200503log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200504 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
505 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100506 configured with "log global".
507
508 <address> can be one of:
509
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100510 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100511 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
512 port).
513
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100514 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
515 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
516 port).
517
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100518 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
519 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
520 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
521 writeable).
522
523 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200524
525 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
526 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
527 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
528
529 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200530 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
531 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
532 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
533 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
534 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
535 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200536
537 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
538
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100539log-send-hostname [<string>]
540 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
541 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
542 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
543 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
544 the logs.
545
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000546log-tag <string>
547 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
548 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
549 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
550 running on the same host.
551
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200552nbproc <number>
553 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
554 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
555 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
556 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
557 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
558
559pidfile <pidfile>
560 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
561 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
562 starting the process. See also "daemon".
563
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200564stats socket <path> [{uid | user} <uid>] [{gid | group} <gid>] [mode <mode>]
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200565 [level <level>]
566
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200567 Creates a UNIX socket in stream mode at location <path>. Any previously
568 existing socket will be backed up then replaced. Connections to this socket
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100569 will return various statistics outputs and even allow some commands to be
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200570 issued. Please consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
571
572 An optional "level" parameter can be specified to restrict the nature of
573 the commands that can be issued on the socket :
574 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
575 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
576 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
577
578 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +0200579 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200580 counters).
581
582 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
583 all counters).
Willy Tarreaua8efd362008-01-03 10:19:15 +0100584
585 On platforms which support it, it is possible to restrict access to this
586 socket by specifying numerical IDs after "uid" and "gid", or valid user and
587 group names after the "user" and "group" keywords. It is also possible to
588 restrict permissions on the socket by passing an octal value after the "mode"
589 keyword (same syntax as chmod). Depending on the platform, the permissions on
590 the socket will be inherited from the directory which hosts it, or from the
591 user the process is started with.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200592
593stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
594 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
595 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100596 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200597
598stats maxconn <connections>
599 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
600 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
601
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200602uid <number>
603 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
604 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
605 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
606 one. See also "gid" and "user".
607
608ulimit-n <number>
609 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
610 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
611 option.
612
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100613unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
614 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
615
616 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
617 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
618 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
619 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
620 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
621 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
622 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
623 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
624 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
625 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
626
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200627user <user name>
628 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
629 See also "uid" and "group".
630
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200631node <name>
632 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
633
634 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
635 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
636 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
637 traffic.
638
639description <text>
640 Add a text that describes the instance.
641
642 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
643 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
644 "<" and ">" characters.
645
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200646
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006473.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200648-----------------------
649
650maxconn <number>
651 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
652 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
653 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
654 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
655
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200656maxconnrate <number>
657 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
658 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
659 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
660 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
661 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
662 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
663 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
664 fairness.
665
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100666maxpipes <number>
667 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
668 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
669 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
670 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
671 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
672 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
673
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200674noepoll
675 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
676 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
677 used will generally be "poll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
678
679nokqueue
680 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
681 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
682 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
683
684nopoll
685 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
686 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100687 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200688 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll" and
689 "nokqueue".
690
691nosepoll
692 Disables the use of the "speculative epoll" event polling system on Linux. It
693 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-ds". The next polling system
694 used will generally be "epoll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
695
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100696nosplice
697 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
698 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
699 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100700 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100701 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
702 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
703 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
704 "option splice-response".
705
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200706spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
707 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending health checks to servers at exact
708 intervals, for instance when many logical servers are located on the same
709 physical server. With the help of this parameter, it becomes possible to add
710 some randomness in the check interval between 0 and +/- 50%. A value between
711 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The default value remains at 0.
712
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200713tune.bufsize <number>
714 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
715 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
716 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
717 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
718 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
719 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
720 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
721 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
722
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200723tune.chksize <number>
724 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
725 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
726 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
727 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
728 checks whenever possible.
729
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200730tune.http.maxhdr <number>
731 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
732 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
733 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
734 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
735 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
736 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
737 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
738 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
739 limit too high.
740
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100741tune.maxaccept <number>
742 Sets the maximum number of consecutive accepts that a process may perform on
743 a single wake up. High values give higher priority to high connection rates,
744 while lower values give higher priority to already established connections.
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100745 This value is limited to 100 by default in single process mode. However, in
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100746 multi-process mode (nbproc > 1), it defaults to 8 so that when one process
747 wakes up, it does not take all incoming connections for itself and leaves a
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100748 part of them to other processes. Setting this value to -1 completely disables
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100749 the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
750
751tune.maxpollevents <number>
752 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
753 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
754 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
755 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
756 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
757
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200758tune.maxrewrite <number>
759 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
760 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
761 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
762 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
763 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
764 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
765 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
766 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
767 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
768 bufsize.
769
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200770tune.pipesize <number>
771 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
772 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
773 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
774 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
775 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
776 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
777
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100778tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
779tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
780 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
781 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
782 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
783 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
784 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
785 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
786 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
787
788tune.sndbuf.client <number>
789tune.sndbuf.server <number>
790 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
791 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
792 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
793 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
794 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
795 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
796 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
797 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
798 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
799 notifying haproxy again.
800
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200801
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008023.3. Debugging
803--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200804
805debug
806 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
807 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
808 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
809 system startup.
810
811quiet
812 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
813 line argument "-q".
814
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200815
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008163.4. Userlists
817--------------
818It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
819http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
820it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
821
822userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100823 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100824 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
825
826group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100827 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100828 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
829 proceeded by "users" keyword.
830
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100831user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
832 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100833 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
834 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100835 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
836 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100837 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
838 DES-based method of crypting passwords.
839
840
841 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100842 userlist L1
843 group G1 users tiger,scott
844 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100845
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100846 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
847 user scott insecure-password elgato
848 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100849
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100850 userlist L2
851 group G1
852 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100853
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100854 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
855 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
856 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100857
858 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200859
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200860
8613.5. Peers
862--------------
863It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
864haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
865pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
866identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
867or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
868Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
869known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
870the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
871process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
872during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
873tables.
874
875peers <peersect>
876 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independant section,
877 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
878
879peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
880 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
881 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
882 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
883 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
884 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
885 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
886
887 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
888 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
889
890 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
891 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
892 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
893 across all peers.
894
895Example:
896 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100897 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
898 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
899 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200900
901 backend mybackend
902 mode tcp
903 balance roundrobin
904 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
905 stick on src
906
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100907 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
908 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200909
910
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009114. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200912----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100913
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200914Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
915 - defaults <name>
916 - frontend <name>
917 - backend <name>
918 - listen <name>
919
920A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
921its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
922section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100923section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200924
925A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
926connections.
927
928A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
929to forward incoming connections.
930
931A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
932parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
933
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100934All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
935'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
936case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
937
938Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
939logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
940proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
941However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
942name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
943
944Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
945and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100946bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100947protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
948modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
949arbitrary criteria.
950
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100951
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009524.1. Proxy keywords matrix
953--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100954
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200955The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
956limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
957they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
958limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100959marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200960option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +0200961and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
962with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
963specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100964
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200965
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100966 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
967------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
968acl - X X X
969appsession - - X X
970backlog X X X -
971balance X - X X
972bind - X X -
973bind-process X X X X
974block - X X X
975capture cookie - X X -
976capture request header - X X -
977capture response header - X X -
978clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
979contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
980cookie X - X X
981default-server X - X X
982default_backend X X X -
983description - X X X
984disabled X X X X
985dispatch - - X X
986enabled X X X X
987errorfile X X X X
988errorloc X X X X
989errorloc302 X X X X
990-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
991errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +0200992force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100993fullconn X - X X
994grace X X X X
995hash-type X - X X
996http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +0100997http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +0200998http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100999http-request - X X X
1000id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001001ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001002log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001003maxconn X X X -
1004mode X X X X
1005monitor fail - X X -
1006monitor-net X X X -
1007monitor-uri X X X -
1008option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1009option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1010option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1011option allbackups (*) X - X X
1012option checkcache (*) X - X X
1013option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1014option contstats (*) X X X -
1015option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1016option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1017option forceclose (*) X X X X
1018-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1019option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001020option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001021option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001022option http-server-close (*) X X X X
1023option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1024option httpchk X - X X
1025option httpclose (*) X X X X
1026option httplog X X X X
1027option http_proxy (*) X X X X
1028option independant-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001029option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001030option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1031option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1032option logasap (*) X X X -
1033option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001034option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001035option nolinger (*) X X X X
1036option originalto X X X X
1037option persist (*) X - X X
1038option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001039option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001040option smtpchk X - X X
1041option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1042option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1043option splice-request (*) X X X X
1044option splice-response (*) X X X X
1045option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1046option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1047-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1048option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1049option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1050option tcpka X X X X
1051option tcplog X X X X
1052option transparent (*) X - X X
1053persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1054rate-limit sessions X X X -
1055redirect - X X X
1056redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1057redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1058reqadd - X X X
1059reqallow - X X X
1060reqdel - X X X
1061reqdeny - X X X
1062reqiallow - X X X
1063reqidel - X X X
1064reqideny - X X X
1065reqipass - X X X
1066reqirep - X X X
1067reqisetbe - X X X
1068reqitarpit - X X X
1069reqpass - X X X
1070reqrep - X X X
1071-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1072reqsetbe - X X X
1073reqtarpit - X X X
1074retries X - X X
1075rspadd - X X X
1076rspdel - X X X
1077rspdeny - X X X
1078rspidel - X X X
1079rspideny - X X X
1080rspirep - X X X
1081rsprep - X X X
1082server - - X X
1083source X - X X
1084srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001085stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001086stats auth X - X X
1087stats enable X - X X
1088stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001089stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001090stats realm X - X X
1091stats refresh X - X X
1092stats scope X - X X
1093stats show-desc X - X X
1094stats show-legends X - X X
1095stats show-node X - X X
1096stats uri X - X X
1097-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1098stick match - - X X
1099stick on - - X X
1100stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001101stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001102stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001103tcp-request connection - X X -
1104tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001105tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001106tcp-response content - - X X
1107tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001108timeout check X - X X
1109timeout client X X X -
1110timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1111timeout connect X - X X
1112timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1113timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1114timeout http-request X X X X
1115timeout queue X - X X
1116timeout server X - X X
1117timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1118timeout tarpit X X X X
1119transparent (deprecated) X - X X
1120use_backend - X X -
1121------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1122 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001123
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001124
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011254.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1126---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001127
1128This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1129
1130
1131acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1132 Declare or complete an access list.
1133 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1134 no | yes | yes | yes
1135 Example:
1136 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1137 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1138 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1139
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001140 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001141
1142
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001143appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1144 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001145 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1146 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1147 no | no | yes | yes
1148 Arguments :
1149 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1150 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1151
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001152 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001153 checked in each cookie value.
1154
1155 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1156 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1157 milliseconds.
1158
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001159 request-learn
1160 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1161 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1162 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1163 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1164 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1165 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1166
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001167 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1168 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1169 data following this prefix.
1170
1171 Example :
1172 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1173
1174 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1175 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1176
1177 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1178 2 modes are currently supported :
1179 - path-parameters :
1180 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1181 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1182 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1183 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1184 - query-string :
1185 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1186 query string.
1187
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001188 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1189 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1190 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1191 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001192 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1193 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1194 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001195 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1196 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1197
1198 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1199
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001200 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1201 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1202 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1203
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001204 Example :
1205 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1206
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001207 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1208 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001209
1210
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001211backlog <conns>
1212 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1213 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1214 yes | yes | yes | no
1215 Arguments :
1216 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1217 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
1218 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
1219
1220 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1221 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1222 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1223 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1224 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1225 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1226 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1227 backlog parameter.
1228
1229 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1230 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1231 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1232
1233 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1234
1235
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001236balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001237balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001238 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1239 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1240 yes | no | yes | yes
1241 Arguments :
1242 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1243 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1244 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1245 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1246
1247 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1248 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1249 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1250 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001251 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
1252 design to 4128 active servers per backend. Note that in some
1253 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1254 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1255 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1256 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1257 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1258 it, so that you don't worry.
1259
1260 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1261 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1262 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1263 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1264 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1265 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1266 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1267 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001268
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001269 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1270 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1271 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1272 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1273 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1274 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1275 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1276 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1277
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001278 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
1279 connection. The servers are choosen from the lowest numeric
1280 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1281 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
1282 reaaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
1283 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1284 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1285 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1286 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1287 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
1288 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too.
1289
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001290 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1291 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1292 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1293 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1294 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1295 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1296 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1297 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001298 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001299 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001300 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1301 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1302 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001303
1304 uri The left part of the URI (before the question mark) is hashed
1305 and divided by the total weight of the running servers. The
1306 result designates which server will receive the request. This
1307 ensures that a same URI will always be directed to the same
1308 server as long as no server goes up or down. This is used
1309 with proxy caches and anti-virus proxies in order to maximize
1310 the cache hit rate. Note that this algorithm may only be used
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001311 in an HTTP backend. This algorithm is static by default,
1312 which means that changing a server's weight on the fly will
1313 have no effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001314
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001315 This algorithm support two optional parameters "len" and
1316 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1317 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1318 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1319 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1320 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1321 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1322 URIs start with a leading "/".
1323
1324 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1325 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1326 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1327 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1328
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001329 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001330 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1331
1332 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
1333 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
Willy Tarreau61a21a32011-03-01 20:35:49 +01001334 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
1335 ('?') in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001336 wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the
1337 entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each
1338 request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB
1339 parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The
1340 default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the
1341 required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this
1342 is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first
1343 chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does
1344 not need to wait for more data than the client promised to
1345 send. When Content-Length is present and larger than
1346 <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is
1347 assumed that this will be enough data to search for the
1348 presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that
1349 Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is
1350 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
1351 be randomly balanced if at all.
1352
1353 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1354 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1355 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1356 server will receive the request.
1357
1358 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1359 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1360 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1361 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1362 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001363 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1364 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1365 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001366
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001367 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP request.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001368 Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function, the header
1369 name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the header is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001370 absent or if it does not contain any value, the roundrobin
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001371 algorithm is applied instead.
1372
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001373 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001374 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1375 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1376 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1377
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001378 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1379 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1380 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1381
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001382 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001383 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001384 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1385 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1386 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1387 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1388 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1389 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001390 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001391 used instead.
1392
1393 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1394 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1395 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1396 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1397
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001398 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1399 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1400 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1401
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001402 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
1403
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001404 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001405 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1406 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001407
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001408 balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001409 balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001410
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001411 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1412 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1413 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001414
1415 Examples :
1416 balance roundrobin
1417 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001418 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001419 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1420 balance hdr(host)
1421 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001422
1423 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1424 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1425
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001426 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001427 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1428 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1429 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1430 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1431
1432 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1433 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1434 defaults to 16 kB.
1435
1436 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1437 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1438
1439 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1440 Round Robin.
1441
1442 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1443 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1444 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1445 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1446
1447 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1448
1449 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001450 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001451 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1452 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1453 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001454
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001455 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1456 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001457
1458
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001459bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...]
1460bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] interface <interface>
1461bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] mss <maxseg>
1462bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] transparent
1463bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] id <id>
1464bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] name <name>
1465bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] defer-accept
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001466bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] accept-proxy
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001467bind /<path> [, ...]
1468bind /<path> [, ...] mode <mode>
1469bind /<path> [, ...] [ user <user> | uid <uid> ]
1470bind /<path> [, ...] [ group <user> | gid <gid> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001471 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1472 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1473 no | yes | yes | no
1474 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001475 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1476 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1477 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1478 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001479 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001480
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001481 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1482 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001483 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1484 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1485 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001486 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1487 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1488 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1489 the range.
1490
1491 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1492 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1493 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1494 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1495 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1496 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1497 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
1498 privileges to start the program, which are independant of
1499 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001500
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001501 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1502 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1503 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1504 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1505 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1506 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1507 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1508 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1509
Willy Tarreau5e6e2042009-02-04 17:19:29 +01001510 <interface> is an optional physical interface name. This is currently
1511 only supported on Linux. The interface must be a physical
1512 interface, not an aliased interface. When specified, all
1513 addresses on the same line will only be accepted if the
1514 incoming packet physically come through the designated
1515 interface. It is also possible to bind multiple frontends to
1516 the same address if they are bound to different interfaces.
1517 Note that binding to a physical interface requires root
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001518 privileges. This parameter is only compatible with TCP
1519 sockets.
Willy Tarreau5e6e2042009-02-04 17:19:29 +01001520
Willy Tarreaube1b9182009-06-14 18:48:19 +02001521 <maxseg> is an optional TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be
1522 advertised on incoming connections. This can be used to force
1523 a lower MSS for certain specific ports, for instance for
1524 connections passing through a VPN. Note that this relies on a
1525 kernel feature which is theorically supported under Linux but
1526 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not
Willy Tarreau48a7e722010-12-24 15:26:39 +01001527 work on other operating systems. It may also not change the
1528 advertised value but change the effective size of outgoing
1529 segments. The commonly advertised value on Ethernet networks
1530 is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is positive,
1531 it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it
1532 will indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's
1533 advertised MSS for outgoing segments. This parameter is only
1534 compatible with TCP sockets.
Willy Tarreaube1b9182009-06-14 18:48:19 +02001535
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02001536 <id> is a persistent value for socket ID. Must be positive and
1537 unique in the proxy. An unused value will automatically be
1538 assigned if unset. Can only be used when defining only a
1539 single socket.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02001540
1541 <name> is an optional name provided for stats
1542
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001543 <mode> is the octal mode used to define access permissions on the
1544 UNIX socket. It can also be set by default in the global
1545 section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms
1546 simply ignore this.
1547
1548 <user> is the name of user that will be marked owner of the UNIX
1549 socket. It can also be set by default in the global
1550 section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms
1551 simply ignore this.
1552
1553 <group> is the name of a group that will be used to create the UNIX
1554 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1555 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1556 this.
1557
1558 <uid> is the uid of user that will be marked owner of the UNIX
1559 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1560 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1561 this.
1562
1563 <gid> is the gid of a group that will be used to create the UNIX
1564 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1565 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1566 this.
1567
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001568 transparent is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain
1569 Linux kernels. It indicates that the addresses will be bound
1570 even if they do not belong to the local machine. Any packet
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001571 targeting any of these addresses will be caught just as if
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001572 the address was locally configured. This normally requires
1573 that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with
1574 the default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for
1575 the specified port. This keyword is available only when
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001576 HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1. This parameter is
1577 only compatible with TCP sockets.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001578
Willy Tarreau59f89202010-10-02 11:54:00 +02001579 defer-accept is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain
Willy Tarreaucb6cd432009-10-13 07:34:14 +02001580 Linux kernels. It states that a connection will only be
1581 accepted once some data arrive on it, or at worst after the
1582 first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols for
1583 which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly
1584 improve performance by ensuring that most of the request is
1585 already available when the connection is accepted. On the
1586 other hand, it will not be able to detect connections which
1587 don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
1588 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is
1589 never accepted until the client talks. This can cause issues
1590 with front firewalls which would see an established
1591 connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV.
1592
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001593 accept-proxy is an optional keyword which enforces use of the PROXY
1594 protocol over any connection accepted by this listener. The
1595 PROXY protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of the
1596 incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used,
1597 with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules
1598 which will only see the real connection address. Logs will
1599 reflect the addresses indicated in the protocol, unless it is
1600 violated, in which case the real address will still be used.
1601 This keyword combined with support from external components
1602 can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
1603 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and
1604 not even always usable.
1605
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001606 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1607 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1608 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1609 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1610 in a frontend.
1611
1612 Example :
1613 listen http_proxy
1614 bind :80,:443
1615 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001616 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001617
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001618 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001619 documentation.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001620
1621
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001622bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32> ] ...
1623 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1624 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1625 yes | yes | yes | yes
1626 Arguments :
1627 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1628 may be used to override a default value.
1629
1630 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1631 option may be combined with other numbers.
1632
1633 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1634 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1635 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1636 missing from all processes.
1637
1638 number The instance will be enabled on this process number, between
1639 1 and 32. You must be careful not to reference a process
1640 number greater than the configured global.nbproc, otherwise
1641 some instances might be missing from all processes.
1642
1643 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1644 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1645 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1646 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1647 and 'even' instances.
1648
1649 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1650 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1651 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1652 32.
1653
1654 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1655 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1656
1657 Example :
1658 listen app_ip1
1659 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001660 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001661
1662 listen app_ip2
1663 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001664 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001665
1666 listen management
1667 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001668 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001669
1670 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1671
1672
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001673block { if | unless } <condition>
1674 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1675 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1676 no | yes | yes | yes
1677
1678 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1679 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001680 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001681 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001682 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1683 "block" statements per instance.
1684
1685 Example:
1686 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1687 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1688 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1689 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1690
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001691 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001692
1693
1694capture cookie <name> len <length>
1695 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1696 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1697 no | yes | yes | no
1698 Arguments :
1699 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1700 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1701 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1702 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1703 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1704
1705 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1706 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1707 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1708 right if it exceeds <length>.
1709
1710 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1711 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1712 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1713 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1714
1715 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1716 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1717 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1718
1719 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1720 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1721 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
1722 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001723 configured in the sources by default to 64 characters. It is not possible to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001724 specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1725
1726 Example:
1727 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1728
1729 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001730 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001731
1732
1733capture request header <name> len <length>
1734 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified request header.
1735 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1736 no | yes | yes | no
1737 Arguments :
1738 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001739 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001740 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1741 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1742 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1743
1744 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1745 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1746 it exceeds <length>.
1747
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001748 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001749 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1750 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001751 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1752 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1753 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1754 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001755 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001756 environments to find where the request came from.
1757
1758 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1759 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1760 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1761 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001762
1763 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers, but each capture
1764 is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent for a
1765 same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It is not
1766 possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1767
1768 Example:
1769 capture request header Host len 15
1770 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1771 capture request header Referrer len 15
1772
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001773 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001774 about logging.
1775
1776
1777capture response header <name> len <length>
1778 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified response header.
1779 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1780 no | yes | yes | no
1781 Arguments :
1782 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001783 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001784 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1785 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1786 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1787
1788 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1789 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1790 it exceeds <length>.
1791
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001792 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001793 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1794 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1795 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001796 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
1797 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
1798 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
1799 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001800
1801 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers, but each
1802 capture is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent
1803 for a same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It
1804 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1805
1806 Example:
1807 capture response header Content-length len 9
1808 capture response header Location len 15
1809
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001810 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001811 about logging.
1812
1813
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001814clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001815 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
1816 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1817 yes | yes | yes | no
1818 Arguments :
1819 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1820 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1821 as explained at the top of this document.
1822
1823 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
1824 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
1825 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
1826 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
1827 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
1828 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
1829 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
1830 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001831 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001832 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
1833 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
1834
1835 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
1836 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1837 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1838 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1839 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
1840 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1841
1842 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
1843 Please use "timeout client" instead.
1844
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01001845 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
1846 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001847
1848
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001849contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001850 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
1851 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1852 yes | no | yes | yes
1853 Arguments :
1854 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1855 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1856 as explained at the top of this document.
1857
1858 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001859 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001860 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001861 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
1862 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
1863 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
1864 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
1865
1866 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
1867 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1868 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1869 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1870 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
1871 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1872
1873 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
1874 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
1875 instead.
1876
1877 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
1878 "timeout server", "contimeout".
1879
1880
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02001881cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001882 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ domain <domain> ]*
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001883 [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001884 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
1885 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1886 yes | no | yes | yes
1887 Arguments :
1888 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
1889 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
1890 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
1891 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
1892 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
1893 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
1894 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
1895 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
1896 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
1897
1898 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
1899 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
1900 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
1901 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
1902 headers is left to the application. The application can then
1903 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
1904 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
1905 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
1906 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
1907 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
1908 "insert" and "prefix".
1909
1910 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001911 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001912
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001913 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001914 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
1915 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
1916 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
1917 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
1918 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
1919 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
1920 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
1921 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
1922 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
1923 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001924
1925 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
1926 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
1927 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
1928 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
1929 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
1930 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
1931 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
1932 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
1933 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
1934 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02001935 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
1936 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
1937 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001938
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001939 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
1940 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
1941 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001942 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
1943 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
1944 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
1945 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02001946 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
1947 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
1948 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001949
1950 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
1951 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
1952 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
1953 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
1954 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
1955 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
1956 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
1957 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
1958 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
1959
1960 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
1961 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
1962 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
1963 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
1964 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
1965 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
1966 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
1967 persistence cookie in the cache.
1968 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
1969
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001970 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
1971 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
1972 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
1973 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
1974 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
1975 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
1976 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
1977 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
1978 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
1979 they logout.
1980
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02001981 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001982 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01001983 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
1984 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
1985 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
1986 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
1987 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
1988 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02001989
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001990 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
1991 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
1992 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
1993 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
1994 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
1995 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
1996 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
1997 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
1998 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
1999 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2000 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2001 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2002 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2003 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2004 the site.
2005
2006 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2007 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2008 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2009 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2010 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2011 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2012 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2013 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2014 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2015 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2016 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2017 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2018 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2019 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2020 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2021 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2022
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002023 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2024 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2025 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2026 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002027
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002028 Examples :
2029 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2030 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2031 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002032 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002033
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002034 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002035 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002036
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002037
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002038default-server [param*]
2039 Change default options for a server in a backend
2040 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2041 yes | no | yes | yes
2042 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002043 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2044 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2045 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2046 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002047
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002048 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002049 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2050
2051 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002052
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002053
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002054default_backend <backend>
2055 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2056 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2057 yes | yes | yes | no
2058 Arguments :
2059 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2060
2061 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2062 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2063 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2064 will catch all undetermined requests.
2065
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002066 Example :
2067
2068 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2069 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2070 default_backend dynamic
2071
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002072 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2073
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002074
2075disabled
2076 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2077 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2078 yes | yes | yes | yes
2079 Arguments : none
2080
2081 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2082 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2083 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2084 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2085 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2086 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2087 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2088
2089 See also : "enabled"
2090
2091
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002092dispatch <address>:<port>
2093 Set a default server address
2094 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2095 no | no | yes | yes
2096 Arguments : none
2097
2098 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2099 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2100 during start-up.
2101
2102 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2103 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2104 possible with normal servers.
2105
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002106 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002107 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2108 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2109 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2110 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2111
2112 See also : "server"
2113
2114
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002115enabled
2116 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2117 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2118 yes | yes | yes | yes
2119 Arguments : none
2120
2121 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2122 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2123
2124 See also : "disabled"
2125
2126
2127errorfile <code> <file>
2128 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2129 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2130 yes | yes | yes | yes
2131 Arguments :
2132 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002133 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002134
2135 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002136 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002137 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002138 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2139 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002140
2141 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2142 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2143 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2144
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002145 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2146
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002147 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2148 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2149 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2150 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2151
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002152 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2153 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2154 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2155 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2156 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2157 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2158
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002159 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2160 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2161 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002162 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002163 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2164
2165 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2166
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002167 Example :
2168 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2169 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2170 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2171
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002172
2173errorloc <code> <url>
2174errorloc302 <code> <url>
2175 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2176 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2177 yes | yes | yes | yes
2178 Arguments :
2179 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002180 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002181
2182 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2183 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2184 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2185 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2186 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2187
2188 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2189 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2190 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2191
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002192 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2193
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002194 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2195 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2196 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2197 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2198 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2199 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2200 request.
2201
2202 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2203
2204
2205errorloc303 <code> <url>
2206 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2207 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2208 yes | yes | yes | yes
2209 Arguments :
2210 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2211 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2212
2213 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2214 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2215 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2216 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2217 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2218
2219 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2220 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2221 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2222
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002223 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2224
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002225 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2226 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2227 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2228 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002229 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002230
2231 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2232
2233
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002234force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2235 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2236 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2237 no | yes | yes | yes
2238
2239 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2240 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2241 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2242 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2243 marked down for maintenance operations.
2244
2245 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2246 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2247 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2248 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2249 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2250 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2251 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2252 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2253 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2254
2255 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2256 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2257 is used.
2258
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002259 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002260 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002261
2262
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002263fullconn <conns>
2264 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2265 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2266 yes | no | yes | yes
2267 Arguments :
2268 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2269 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2270
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002271 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002272 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002273 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002274 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2275 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2276 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2277 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2278 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002279 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002280
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002281 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2282 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
2283 backend. That way it's safe to leave it unset.
2284
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002285 Example :
2286 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2287 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2288 # connections.
2289 backend dynamic
2290 fullconn 10000
2291 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2292 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2293
2294 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2295
2296
2297grace <time>
2298 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2299 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002300 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002301 Arguments :
2302 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2303 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2304 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2305
2306 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2307 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002308 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002309 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2310
2311 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2312 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2313 simplify it.
2314
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002315
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002316hash-type <method>
2317 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2318 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2319 yes | no | yes | yes
2320 Arguments :
2321 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2322 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but will
2323 be static in that weight changes while a server is up will be
2324 ignored. This means that there will be no slow start. Also,
2325 since a server is selected by its position in the array, most
2326 mappings are changed when the server count changes. This means
2327 that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is added
2328 to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to different
2329 servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for instance.
2330
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002331 avalanche this mechanism uses the default map-based hashing described
2332 above but applies a full avalanche hash before performing the
2333 mapping. The result is a slightly less smooth hash for most
2334 situations, but the hash becomes better than pure map-based
2335 hashes when the number of servers is a multiple of the size of
2336 the input set. When using URI hash with a number of servers
2337 multiple of 64, it's desirable to change the hash type to
2338 this value.
2339
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002340 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2341 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2342 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2343 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2344 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2345 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a server
2346 is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings are
2347 redistributed, making it an ideal algorithm for caches.
2348 However, due to its principle, the algorithm will never be very
2349 smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a server's
2350 weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution. In order
2351 to get the same distribution on multiple load balancers, it is
2352 important that all servers have the same IDs.
2353
2354 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages.
2355
2356 See also : "balance", "server"
2357
2358
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002359http-check disable-on-404
2360 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2361 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002362 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002363 Arguments : none
2364
2365 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2366 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2367 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2368 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2369 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2370 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2371 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2372 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002373 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2374 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2375 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2376
2377 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2378
2379
2380http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
2381 Make HTTP health checks consider reponse contents or specific status codes
2382 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002383 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002384 Arguments :
2385 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2386 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
2387 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceeded by an
2388 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2389 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2390 details on the supported keywords.
2391
2392 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2393 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2394 with the usual backslash ('\').
2395
2396 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2397 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2398 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2399 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2400 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2401
2402 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
2403 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2404 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2405 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2406 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2407
2408 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
2409 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2410 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2411 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2412 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2413 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2414
2415 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
2416 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2417 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2418 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2419 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2420 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2421 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2422 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2423 trace).
2424
2425 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
2426 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2427 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2428 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2429 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2430 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2431 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2432 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2433
2434 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2435 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2436 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2437 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2438 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2439 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2440 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2441 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2442
2443 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2444 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2445
2446 Examples :
2447 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002448 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002449
2450 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002451 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002452
2453 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002454 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002455
2456 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002457 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002458
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002459 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002460
2461
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002462http-check send-state
2463 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2464 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2465 yes | no | yes | yes
2466 Arguments : none
2467
2468 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2469 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2470 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2471 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2472 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2473
2474 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2475 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2476 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2477 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2478 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2479 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2480 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2481 checked in multiple backends.
2482
2483 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2484 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2485
2486 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2487 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2488 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2489 one fails.
2490
2491 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2492 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2493 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2494
2495 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2496 server's queue.
2497
2498 Example of a header received by the application server :
2499 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2500 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2501
2502 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2503
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002504http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002505 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002506 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2507
2508 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2509 no | yes | yes | yes
2510
2511 These set of options allow to fine control access to a
2512 frontend/listen/backend. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
2513 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002514 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
2515 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002516 should be asked to enter a username and password.
2517
2518 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
2519 instance.
2520
2521 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002522 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2523 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2524 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002525
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002526 http-request allow if nagios
2527 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2528 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2529 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002530
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002531 Example:
2532 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002533
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002534 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002535
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002536 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2537 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002538
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05002539http-send-name-header [<header>]
2540 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
2541
2542 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2543 yes | no | yes | yes
2544
2545 Arguments :
2546
2547 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
2548
2549 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
2550 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
2551 is added with the header string proved.
2552
2553 See also : "server"
2554
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002555id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02002556 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
2557 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2558 no | yes | yes | yes
2559 Arguments : none
2560
2561 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
2562 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
2563 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002564
2565
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002566ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2567 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
2568 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2569 no | yes | yes | yes
2570
2571 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
2572 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
2573 and running).
2574
2575 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2576 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
2577 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
2578 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
2579 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
2580
2581 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
2582 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
2583
2584 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2585 "unless" condition is met.
2586
2587 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
2588
2589
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002590log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002591log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002592no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002593 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
2594 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2595 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002596
2597 Prefix :
2598 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
2599 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
2600 prefix does not allow arguments.
2601
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002602 Arguments :
2603 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
2604 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
2605 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
2606 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
2607 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
2608 parameter.
2609
2610 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
2611 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
2612
2613 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
2614 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2615 standard syslog port).
2616
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01002617 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
2618 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2619 standard syslog port).
2620
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002621 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
2622 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
2623 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
2624 appropriately writeable).
2625
2626 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
2627
2628 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
2629 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
2630 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
2631
2632 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
2633 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
2634 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002635 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
2636 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
2637 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
2638 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
2639 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002640
2641 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2642
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002643 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
2644 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
2645 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002646
2647 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
2648 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
2649 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
2650 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
2651
2652 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
2653 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002654
2655 Example :
2656 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002657 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
2658 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002659
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01002660log-format <string>
2661 Allows you to custom a log line.
2662
2663 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
2664
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002665
2666maxconn <conns>
2667 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
2668 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2669 yes | yes | yes | no
2670 Arguments :
2671 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
2672 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
2673 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
2674 closes.
2675
2676 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
2677 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
2678 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
2679 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
2680 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
2681 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
2682 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
2683 properly tuned.
2684
2685 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
2686 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
2687 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
2688
2689 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
2690
2691
2692mode { tcp|http|health }
2693 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
2694 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2695 yes | yes | yes | yes
2696 Arguments :
2697 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
2698 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
2699 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
2700 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
2701
2702 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
2703 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
2704 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
2705 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
2706 brings HAProxy most of its value.
2707
2708 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
2709 to incoming connections and close the connection. Nothing will be
2710 logged. This mode is used to reply to external components health
2711 checks. This mode is deprecated and should not be used anymore as
2712 it is possible to do the same and even better by combining TCP or
2713 HTTP modes with the "monitor" keyword.
2714
2715 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
2716 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
2717 will be refused.
2718
2719 Example :
2720 defaults http_instances
2721 mode http
2722
2723 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
2724
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002725
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002726monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002727 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002728 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2729 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002730 Arguments :
2731 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
2732 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002733 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002734 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
2735 backend and its backup.
2736
2737 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
2738 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
2739 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
2740 servers in a list of backends.
2741
2742 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
2743 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
2744 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
2745 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
2746 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
2747 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
2748 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002749 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
2750 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002751
2752 Example:
2753 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002754 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002755 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
2756 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
2757 monitor-uri /site_alive
2758 monitor fail if site_dead
2759
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002760 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002761
2762
2763monitor-net <source>
2764 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
2765 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2766 yes | yes | yes | no
2767 Arguments :
2768 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
2769 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
2770 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
2771 followed by a mask.
2772
2773 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
2774 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002775 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002776 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
2777
2778 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
2779 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
2780 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
2781 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
2782 running without forwarding the request to a backend server.
2783
2784 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2785 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2786 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2787 nothing more. Right now, it is not possible to set failure conditions on
2788 requests caught by "monitor-net".
2789
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01002790 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
2791 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
2792
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002793 Example :
2794 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
2795 frontend www
2796 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
2797
2798 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
2799
2800
2801monitor-uri <uri>
2802 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
2803 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2804 yes | yes | yes | no
2805 Arguments :
2806 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
2807 health status instead of forwarding the request.
2808
2809 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
2810 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
2811 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
2812 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
2813 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
2814 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
2815 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
2816 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
2817
2818 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2819 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2820 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2821 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
2822 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
2823 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
2824
2825 Example :
2826 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
2827 frontend www
2828 mode http
2829 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
2830
2831 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
2832
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002833
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002834option abortonclose
2835no option abortonclose
2836 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
2837 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2838 yes | no | yes | yes
2839 Arguments : none
2840
2841 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
2842 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
2843 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
2844 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002845 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002846 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
2847 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
2848 encountered while delivering the response.
2849
2850 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
2851 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
2852 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
2853 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
2854 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
2855 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002856 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002857 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002858 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002859 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
2860 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
2861 still not served and not pollute the servers.
2862
2863 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
2864 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
2865 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
2866 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
2867 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
2868 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
2869 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
2870 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002871 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002872
2873 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2874 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2875
2876 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
2877
2878
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002879option accept-invalid-http-request
2880no option accept-invalid-http-request
2881 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
2882 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2883 yes | yes | yes | no
2884 Arguments : none
2885
2886 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2887 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2888 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2889 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2890 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2891 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2892 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2893 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01002894 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
2895 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
2896 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
2897 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
2898 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
2899 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002900
2901 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2902 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2903 been confirmed.
2904
2905 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2906 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01002907 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
2908 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002909 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2910
2911 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2912 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2913
2914 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
2915 stats socket.
2916
2917
2918option accept-invalid-http-response
2919no option accept-invalid-http-response
2920 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
2921 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2922 yes | no | yes | yes
2923 Arguments : none
2924
2925 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2926 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2927 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2928 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2929 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2930 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2931 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2932 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
2933 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
2934
2935 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2936 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2937 been confirmed.
2938
2939 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2940 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
2941 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
2942 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2943
2944 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2945 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2946
2947 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
2948 stats socket.
2949
2950
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002951option allbackups
2952no option allbackups
2953 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
2954 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2955 yes | no | yes | yes
2956 Arguments : none
2957
2958 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
2959 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
2960 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
2961 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
2962 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
2963 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
2964 order between the backup servers anymore.
2965
2966 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
2967 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
2968
2969 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2970 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2971
2972
2973option checkcache
2974no option checkcache
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002975 Analyze all server responses and block requests with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002976 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2977 yes | no | yes | yes
2978 Arguments : none
2979
2980 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
2981 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002982 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002983 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
2984 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002985 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002986
2987 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002988 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002989 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002990 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
2991 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002992 to the client are :
2993 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002994 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002995 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002996 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
2997 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
2998 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
2999 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3000 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3001 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3002 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3003 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3004 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3005 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3006 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3007
3008 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003009 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003010 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003011 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003012 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3013
3014 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3015 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003016 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003017 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3018
3019 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3020 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3021
3022
3023option clitcpka
3024no option clitcpka
3025 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3026 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3027 yes | yes | yes | no
3028 Arguments : none
3029
3030 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3031 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3032 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3033 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3034
3035 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3036 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3037 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3038 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3039
3040 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3041 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3042 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3043 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3044 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3045
3046 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3047
3048 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3049 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3050 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3051
3052 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3053 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3054
3055 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3056
3057
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003058option contstats
3059 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3060 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3061 yes | yes | yes | no
3062 Arguments : none
3063
3064 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3065 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3066 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3067 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3068 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3069 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3070 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3071
3072
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003073option dontlog-normal
3074no option dontlog-normal
3075 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3076 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3077 yes | yes | yes | no
3078 Arguments : none
3079
3080 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3081 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3082 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3083 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3084 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3085 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3086 logged.
3087
3088 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3089 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3090 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3091
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003092 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003093 logging.
3094
3095
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003096option dontlognull
3097no option dontlognull
3098 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3099 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3100 yes | yes | yes | no
3101 Arguments : none
3102
3103 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3104 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3105 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3106 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3107 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3108 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3109 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3110
3111 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3112 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3113 would not be logged.
3114
3115 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3116 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3117
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003118 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003119
3120
3121option forceclose
3122no option forceclose
3123 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3124 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003125 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003126 Arguments : none
3127
3128 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3129 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3130 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3131 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3132 global session times in the logs.
3133
3134 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003135 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003136 to respond. This option implicitly enables the "httpclose" option. Note that
3137 this option also enables the parsing of the full request and response, which
3138 means we can close the connection to the server very quickly, releasing some
3139 resources earlier than with httpclose.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003140
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003141 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3142 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3143 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3144
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003145 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3146 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3147
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003148 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003149
3150
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003151option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003152 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3153 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3154 yes | yes | yes | yes
3155 Arguments :
3156 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3157 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003158 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003159 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003160
3161 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3162 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3163 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3164 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3165 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3166 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3167 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003168 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3169 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3170 possible that the client has already brought one.
3171
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003172 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003173 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003174 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3175 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003176 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3177 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003178
3179 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3180 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3181 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3182 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3183 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3184 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3185 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3186
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003187 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
3188 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
3189 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
3190 are under the control of the end-user.
3191
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003192 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003193 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3194 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003195 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
3196 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
3197 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003198
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003199 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3200 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3201 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3202 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3203 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003204
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003205 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003206 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3207 frontend www
3208 mode http
3209 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3210
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003211 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3212 backend www
3213 mode http
3214 option forwardfor header X-Client
3215
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003216 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3217 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003218
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003219
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003220option http-no-delay
3221no option http-no-delay
3222 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
3223 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3224 yes | yes | yes | yes
3225 Arguments : none
3226
3227 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
3228 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
3229 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
3230 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
3231 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
3232 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
3233 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
3234 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
3235 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
3236 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
3237 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
3238 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
3239 affected.
3240
3241 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
3242 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
3243 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
3244 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
3245 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
3246 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
3247 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
3248 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
3249 latency environments.
3250
3251
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003252option http-pretend-keepalive
3253no option http-pretend-keepalive
3254 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
3255 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3256 yes | yes | yes | yes
3257 Arguments : none
3258
3259 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
3260 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
3261 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
3262 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
3263 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
3264 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
3265 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
3266 consider the response complete.
3267
3268 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
3269 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
3270 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
3271 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
3272 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
3273 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
3274
3275 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
3276 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
3277 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
3278 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
3279 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
3280 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
3281 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
3282
3283 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3284 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02003285 This option may be compbined with "option httpclose", which will cause
3286 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
3287 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003288
3289 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3290 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3291
3292 See also : "option forceclose" and "option http-server-close"
3293
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003294
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003295option http-server-close
3296no option http-server-close
3297 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
3298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3299 yes | yes | yes | yes
3300 Arguments : none
3301
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003302 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3303 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
3304 "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server
3305 side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on
3306 the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
3307 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
3308 resources, similarly to "option forceclose". It also permits non-keepalive
3309 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
3310 conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note that some servers do not
3311 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
3312 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
3313 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003314
3315 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3316 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3317 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3318 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01003319 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3320 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003321
3322 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3323 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003324 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" has precedence over "option
3325 http-server-close" and that combining "http-server-close" with "httpclose"
3326 basically achieve the same result as "forceclose".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003327
3328 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3329 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3330
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003331 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3332 "option httpclose" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003333
3334
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003335option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003336no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003337 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
3338 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3339 yes | yes | yes | no
3340 Arguments : none
3341
3342 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
3343 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
3344 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
3345 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
3346 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
3347 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
3348 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
3349
3350 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
3351 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
3352 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
3353 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
3354 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
3355 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
3356 request along its whole life.
3357
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01003358 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
3359 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
3360 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
3361 front of an existing proxy.
3362
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003363 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
3364
3365 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
3366 http-server-close".
3367
3368
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003369option httpchk
3370option httpchk <uri>
3371option httpchk <method> <uri>
3372option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
3373 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
3374 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3375 yes | no | yes | yes
3376 Arguments :
3377 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
3378 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
3379 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
3380 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
3381 ones.
3382
3383 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
3384 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
3385 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
3386
3387 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
3388 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
3389 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
3390 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
3391 after "\r\n" following the version string.
3392
3393 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
3394 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
3395 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
3396 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
3397 the lack of any response.
3398
3399 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
3400
3401 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
3402 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
3403 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
3404
3405 Examples :
3406 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
3407 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
3408 backend https_relay
3409 mode tcp
3410 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
3411 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
3412
3413 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003414 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
3415 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003416
3417
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003418option httpclose
3419no option httpclose
3420 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
3421 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3422 yes | yes | yes | yes
3423 Arguments : none
3424
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003425 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3426 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. If "option
3427 httpclose" is set, it will check if a "Connection: close" header is already
3428 set in each direction, and will add one if missing. Each end should react to
3429 this by actively closing the TCP connection after each transfer, thus
3430 resulting in a switch to the HTTP close mode. Any "Connection" header
3431 different from "close" will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003432
3433 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003434 close the connection eventhough they reply "Connection: close". For this
3435 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
3436 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
3437 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
3438 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
3439 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003440
3441 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3442 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
3443 If "option forceclose" is specified too, it has precedence over "httpclose".
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003444 If "option http-server-close" is enabled at the same time as "httpclose", it
3445 basically achieves the same result as "option forceclose".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003446
3447 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3448 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3449
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003450 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
3451 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003452
3453
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003454option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003455 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
3456 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3457 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003458 Arguments :
3459 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
3460 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
3461 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
3462 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
3463 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003464
3465 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
3466 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
3467 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
3468 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
3469 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
3470 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
3471 ports.
3472
3473 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
3474
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003475 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3476 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
3477 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
3478 by default.
3479
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003480 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003481
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003482
3483option http_proxy
3484no option http_proxy
3485 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
3486 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3487 yes | yes | yes | yes
3488 Arguments : none
3489
3490 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
3491 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
3492 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
3493 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
3494 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
3495
3496 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
3497 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
3498 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
3499 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01003500 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003501 be analyzed.
3502
3503 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3504 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3505
3506 Example :
3507 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
3508 backend direct_forward
3509 option httpclose
3510 option http_proxy
3511
3512 See also : "option httpclose"
3513
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003514
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003515option independant-streams
3516no option independant-streams
3517 Enable or disable independant timeout processing for both directions
3518 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3519 yes | yes | yes | yes
3520 Arguments : none
3521
3522 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
3523 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
3524 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
3525 receive data or not.
3526
3527 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
3528 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
3529 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
3530 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
3531 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
3532 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
3533 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
3534 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
3535 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
3536 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
3537 socket buffers.
3538
3539 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
3540 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
3541 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
3542 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
3543 slow lines, so use it with caution.
3544
3545 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout server"
3546
3547
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003548option ldap-check
3549 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
3550 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3551 yes | no | yes | yes
3552 Arguments : none
3553
3554 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
3555 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
3556 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
3557 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
3558
3559 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
3560 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
3561
3562 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
3563 configure it.
3564
3565 Example :
3566 option ldap-check
3567
3568 See also : "option httpchk"
3569
3570
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003571option log-health-checks
3572no option log-health-checks
3573 Enable or disable logging of health checks
3574 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3575 yes | no | yes | yes
3576 Arguments : none
3577
3578 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
3579 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
3580 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
3581 of additional information is limited.
3582
3583 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
3584 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
3585
3586 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
3587
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003588
3589option log-separate-errors
3590no option log-separate-errors
3591 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
3592 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3593 yes | yes | yes | no
3594 Arguments : none
3595
3596 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
3597 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
3598 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
3599 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
3600 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
3601 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
3602 provides very important information.
3603
3604 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
3605 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
3606 error logs.
3607
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003608 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003609 logging.
3610
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003611
3612option logasap
3613no option logasap
3614 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
3615 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3616 yes | yes | yes | no
3617 Arguments : none
3618
3619 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
3620 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
3621 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
3622 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
3623 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
3624 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
3625 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003626 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003627 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
3628 bytes are expected to be transferred.
3629
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003630 Examples :
3631 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
3632 mode http
3633 option httplog
3634 option logasap
3635 log 192.168.2.200 local3
3636
3637 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
3638 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
3639 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
3640 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
3641
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003642 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003643 logging.
3644
3645
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003646option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
3647 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003648 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3649 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003650 Arguments :
3651 user <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting
3652 to MySQL server.
3653
3654 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
3655 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
3656 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
3657 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
3658 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
3659 in the MySQL table, like this :
3660
3661 USE mysql;
3662 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
3663 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
3664
3665 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
3666 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
3667 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
3668 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
3669 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
3670 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
3671 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
3672 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
3673 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
3674
3675 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
3676 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003677
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02003678 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003679
3680 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
3681 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
3682 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3683 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3684 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
3685 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
3686
3687 See also: "option httpchk"
3688
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003689option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
3690 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
3691 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3692 yes | no | yes | yes
3693 Arguments :
3694 user <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting
3695 to PostgreSQL server.
3696
3697 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
3698 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
3699 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
3700 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
3701
3702 See also: "option httpchk"
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003703
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003704option nolinger
3705no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003706 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003707 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3708 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003709 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003710
3711 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
3712 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
3713 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
3714 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
3715 connections.
3716
3717 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
3718 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
3719 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
3720 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
3721 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
3722 this too.
3723
3724 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
3725 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
3726 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
3727
3728 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
3729 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
3730 for servers.
3731
3732 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3733 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3734
3735
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003736option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
3737 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
3738 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3739 yes | yes | yes | yes
3740 Arguments :
3741 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3742 matching <network>
3743 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
3744 header name.
3745
3746 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
3747 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
3748 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
3749 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
3750 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
3751 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
3752 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
3753 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
3754 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3755 possible that the client has already brought one.
3756
3757 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
3758 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
3759 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
3760 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
3761 header and requires different one.
3762
3763 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3764 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3765 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3766 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3767 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3768 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3769 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3770
3771 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
3772 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3773 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
3774 both are defined.
3775
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003776 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3777 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3778 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3779 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3780 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003781
3782 Examples :
3783 # Original Destination address
3784 frontend www
3785 mode http
3786 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
3787
3788 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
3789 backend www
3790 mode http
3791 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
3792
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003793 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3794 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003795
3796
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003797option persist
3798no option persist
3799 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
3800 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3801 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003802 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003803
3804 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
3805 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
3806 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
3807 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
3808 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
3809 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
3810 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
3811 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
3812 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
3813 redirected to another valid server.
3814
3815 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3816 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3817
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003818 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003819
3820
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003821option redispatch
3822no option redispatch
3823 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
3824 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3825 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003826 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003827
3828 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
3829 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
3830 be able to access the service anymore.
3831
3832 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
3833 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
3834
3835 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
3836 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
3837 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003838
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003839 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
3840 "redisp" keywords.
3841
3842 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3843 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3844
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003845 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003846
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003847
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003848option redis-check
3849 Use redis health checks for server testing
3850 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3851 yes | no | yes | yes
3852 Arguments : none
3853
3854 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
3855 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
3856 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
3857 find the "+PONG" response message.
3858
3859 Example :
3860 option redis-check
3861
3862 See also : "option httpchk"
3863
3864
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003865option smtpchk
3866option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
3867 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
3868 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3869 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003870 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003871 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
3872 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
3873 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
3874
3875 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
3876 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
3877 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
3878
3879 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
3880 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
3881 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
3882 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
3883 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
3884 dead server.
3885
3886 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
3887 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
3888 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
3889 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
3890
3891 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
3892 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
3893 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3894 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3895 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
3896
3897 Example :
3898 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
3899
3900 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
3901
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003902
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02003903option socket-stats
3904no option socket-stats
3905
3906 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
3907 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3908 yes | yes | yes | no
3909
3910 Arguments : none
3911
3912
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003913option splice-auto
3914no option splice-auto
3915 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
3916 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3917 yes | yes | yes | yes
3918 Arguments : none
3919
3920 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3921 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
3922 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
3923 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003924 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003925 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
3926 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
3927 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
3928 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3929
3930 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
3931 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
3932 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
3933 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
3934 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
3935 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
3936 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
3937 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
3938 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
3939 keyword.
3940
3941 Example :
3942 option splice-auto
3943
3944 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3945 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3946
3947 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
3948 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3949
3950
3951option splice-request
3952no option splice-request
3953 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
3954 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3955 yes | yes | yes | yes
3956 Arguments : none
3957
3958 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3959 will user kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
3960 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3961 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
3962 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
3963 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3964
3965 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
3966
3967 Example :
3968 option splice-request
3969
3970 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3971 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3972
3973 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
3974 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3975
3976
3977option splice-response
3978no option splice-response
3979 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
3980 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3981 yes | yes | yes | yes
3982 Arguments : none
3983
3984 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3985 will user kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
3986 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3987 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
3988 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
3989 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3990
3991 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
3992
3993 Example :
3994 option splice-response
3995
3996 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3997 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3998
3999 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
4000 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4001
4002
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004003option srvtcpka
4004no option srvtcpka
4005 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
4006 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4007 yes | no | yes | yes
4008 Arguments : none
4009
4010 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4011 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4012 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4013 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4014
4015 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4016 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4017 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4018 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4019
4020 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4021 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4022 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4023 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4024 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4025
4026 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4027
4028 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4029 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4030 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
4031
4032 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4033 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4034
4035 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
4036
4037
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004038option ssl-hello-chk
4039 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
4040 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4041 yes | no | yes | yes
4042 Arguments : none
4043
4044 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
4045 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
4046 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
4047 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
4048 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
4049 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
4050 hello message.
4051
4052 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
4053 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
4054 messages, which is appreciable.
4055
4056 See also: "option httpchk"
4057
4058
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004059option tcp-smart-accept
4060no option tcp-smart-accept
4061 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
4062 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4063 yes | yes | yes | no
4064 Arguments : none
4065
4066 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
4067 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
4068 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
4069 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
4070 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
4071 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
4072
4073 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
4074 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
4075 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
4076 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
4077
4078 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
4079 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
4080 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
4081 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
4082
4083 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
4084 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
4085 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
4086
4087 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
4088 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
4089 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
4090
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02004091 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
4092
4093
4094option tcp-smart-connect
4095no option tcp-smart-connect
4096 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
4097 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4098 yes | no | yes | yes
4099 Arguments : none
4100
4101 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
4102 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
4103 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
4104 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
4105 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
4106
4107 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
4108 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
4109 complex.
4110
4111 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
4112 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
4113 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
4114
4115 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4116 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4117
4118 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
4119
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004120
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004121option tcpka
4122 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
4123 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4124 yes | yes | yes | yes
4125 Arguments : none
4126
4127 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4128 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4129 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4130 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4131
4132 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4133 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4134 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4135 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4136
4137 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4138 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4139 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4140 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4141 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4142
4143 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4144
4145 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
4146 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
4147 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
4148 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
4149 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
4150 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
4151 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
4152 backends.
4153
4154 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
4155
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004156
4157option tcplog
4158 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
4159 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4160 yes | yes | yes | yes
4161 Arguments : none
4162
4163 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4164 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4165 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
4166 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
4167 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
4168 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
4169 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
4170 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
4171
4172 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4173
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004174 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004175
4176
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004177option transparent
4178no option transparent
4179 Enable client-side transparent proxying
4180 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01004181 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004182 Arguments : none
4183
4184 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
4185 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
4186 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
4187 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
4188 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
4189 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
4190 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
4191 appropriate server.
4192
4193 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
4194 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
4195
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01004196 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004197 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004198
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004199
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004200persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004201persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004202 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
4203 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4204 yes | no | yes | yes
4205 Arguments :
4206 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004207 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
4208 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004209
4210 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
4211 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
4212 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
4213 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
4214 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
4215 forwarded to this server.
4216
4217 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
4218 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
4219 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004220 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004221 a single "listen" section.
4222
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004223 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
4224 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
4225 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
4226
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004227 Example :
4228 listen tse-farm
4229 bind :3389
4230 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
4231 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
4232 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
4233 # apply RDP cookie persistence
4234 persist rdp-cookie
4235 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
4236 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
4237 balance rdp-cookie
4238 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
4239 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
4240
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09004241 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
4242 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004243
4244
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004245rate-limit sessions <rate>
4246 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
4247 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4248 yes | yes | yes | no
4249 Arguments :
4250 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
4251 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
4252
4253 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
4254 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
4255 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
4256 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
4257 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
4258 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
4259
4260 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
4261 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
4262 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
4263 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
4264
4265 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
4266 listen smtp
4267 mode tcp
4268 bind :25
4269 rate-limit sessions 10
4270 server 127.0.0.1:1025
4271
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02004272 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
4273 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
4274 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004275
4276 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
4277
4278
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004279redirect location <to> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4280redirect prefix <to> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004281 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
4282 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4283 no | yes | yes | yes
4284
4285 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004286 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004287
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004288 Arguments :
4289 <to> With "redirect location", the exact value in <to> is placed into
4290 the HTTP "Location" header. In case of "redirect prefix", the
4291 "Location" header is built from the concatenation of <to> and the
4292 complete URI, including the query string, unless the "drop-query"
Willy Tarreaufe651a52008-11-19 21:15:17 +01004293 option is specified (see below). As a special case, if <to>
4294 equals exactly "/" in prefix mode, then nothing is inserted
4295 before the original URI. It allows one to redirect to the same
4296 URL.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004297
4298 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
4299 is desired. Only codes 301, 302 and 303 are supported, and 302 is
4300 used if no code is specified. 301 means "Moved permanently", and
4301 a browser may cache the Location. 302 means "Moved permanently"
4302 and means that the browser should not cache the redirection. 303
4303 is equivalent to 302 except that the browser will fetch the
4304 location with a GET method.
4305
4306 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
4307 expected behaviour of a redirection :
4308
4309 - "drop-query"
4310 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
4311 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
4312 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
4313 with a location-type redirect.
4314
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004315 - "append-slash"
4316 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
4317 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
4318 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
4319 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
4320
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004321 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
4322 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
4323 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
4324 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
4325 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
4326 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
4327 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
4328
4329 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
4330 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
4331 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
4332 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
4333 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
4334 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
4335 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004336
4337 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
4338 acl clear dst_port 80
4339 acl secure dst_port 8080
4340 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004341 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004342 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004343 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
4344
4345 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004346 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
4347 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
4348 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004349 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004350
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004351 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
4352 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
4353 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
4354
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004355 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004356
4357
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004358redisp (deprecated)
4359redispatch (deprecated)
4360 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4361 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4362 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004363 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004364
4365 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4366 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4367 be able to access the service anymore.
4368
4369 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
4370 redistribute them to a working server.
4371
4372 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4373 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4374 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004375
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004376 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
4377 "option redispatch" instead.
4378
4379 See also : "option redispatch"
4380
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004381
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004382reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004383 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
4384 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4385 no | yes | yes | yes
4386 Arguments :
4387 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4388 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004389 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004390
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004391 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4392 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4393
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004394 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4395 the last header of an HTTP request.
4396
4397 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4398 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4399 responses.
4400
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004401 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
4402 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
4403 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
4404
4405 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4406 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004407
4408
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004409reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4410reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004411 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4412 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4413 no | yes | yes | yes
4414 Arguments :
4415 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4416 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4417 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4418 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4419 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4420 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
4421 ignores case.
4422
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004423 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4424 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4425
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004426 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4427 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
4428 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4429 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004430 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004431
4432 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4433 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4434
4435 Example :
4436 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
4437 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4438 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4439
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004440 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
4441 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004442
4443
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004444reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4445reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004446 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
4447 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4448 no | yes | yes | yes
4449 Arguments :
4450 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4451 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4452 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4453 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4454 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
4455 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
4456
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004457 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4458 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4459
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004460 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
4461 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4462 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
4463 next servers.
4464
4465 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4466 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4467 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4468
4469 Example :
4470 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
4471 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
4472 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
4473
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004474 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4475 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004476
4477
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004478reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4479reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004480 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4481 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4482 no | yes | yes | yes
4483 Arguments :
4484 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4485 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4486 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4487 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4488 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4489 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
4490 case.
4491
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004492 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4493 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4494
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004495 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4496 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
4497 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4498 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004499 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004500
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004501 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004502 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004503 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004504
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004505 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4506 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4507
4508 Example :
4509 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
4510 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4511 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4512
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004513 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4514 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004515
4516
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004517reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4518reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004519 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
4520 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4521 no | yes | yes | yes
4522 Arguments :
4523 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4524 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4525 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4526 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4527 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4528 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
4529 case.
4530
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004531 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4532 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4533
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004534 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4535 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
4536 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
4537 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4538
4539 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4540 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4541
4542 Example :
4543 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
4544 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
4545 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4546 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4547
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004548 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4549 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004550
4551
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004552reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4553reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004554 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
4555 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4556 no | yes | yes | yes
4557 Arguments :
4558 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4559 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4560 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4561 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4562 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
4563 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
4564
4565 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4566 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4567 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4568 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004569 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004570
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004571 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4572 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4573
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004574 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
4575 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
4576 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
4577
4578 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4579 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4580 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4581 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
4582 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4583
4584 Example :
4585 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
4586 reqrep ^([^\ ]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
4587 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
4588 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
4589
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004590 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", section 6 about HTTP header
4591 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004592
4593
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004594reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4595reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004596 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
4597 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4598 no | yes | yes | yes
4599 Arguments :
4600 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4601 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4602 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4603 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4604 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4605 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
4606 ignores case.
4607
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004608 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4609 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4610
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004611 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4612 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004613 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
4614 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
4615 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004616 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
4617 not set.
4618
4619 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
4620 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
4621 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
4622 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
4623 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
4624
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004625 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004626 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
4627 # block all others.
4628 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
4629 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
4630
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004631 # block bad guys
4632 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
4633 reqitarpit . if badguys
4634
4635 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
4636 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004637
4638
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02004639retries <value>
4640 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
4641 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4642 yes | no | yes | yes
4643 Arguments :
4644 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
4645 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
4646 default value is 3.
4647
4648 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
4649 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
4650 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
4651
4652 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
4653 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
4654
4655 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
4656 server even if a cookie references a different server.
4657
4658 See also : "option redispatch"
4659
4660
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004661rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004662 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
4663 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4664 no | yes | yes | yes
4665 Arguments :
4666 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4667 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004668 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004669
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004670 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4671 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4672
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004673 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4674 the last header of an HTTP response.
4675
4676 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4677 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4678 responses.
4679
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004680 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4681 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004682
4683
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004684rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4685rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004686 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
4687 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4688 no | yes | yes | yes
4689 Arguments :
4690 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4691 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4692 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4693 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4694 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4695 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
4696 ignores case.
4697
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004698 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4699 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4700
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004701 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
4702 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004703 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004704 client.
4705
4706 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4707 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4708 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4709
4710 Example :
4711 # remove the Server header from responses
4712 reqidel ^Server:.*
4713
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004714 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4715 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004716
4717
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004718rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4719rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004720 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
4721 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4722 no | yes | yes | yes
4723 Arguments :
4724 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4725 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4726 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4727 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4728 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4729 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
4730 ignores case.
4731
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004732 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4733 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4734
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004735 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4736 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
4737 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
4738 case-sensitive.
4739
4740 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004741 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
4742 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
4743 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004744
4745 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4746 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
4747
4748 Example :
4749 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
4750 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
4751
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004752 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
4753 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004754
4755
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004756rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4757rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004758 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
4759 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4760 no | yes | yes | yes
4761 Arguments :
4762 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4763 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4764 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4765 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4766 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4767 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
4768 ignores case.
4769
4770 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4771 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4772 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4773 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004774 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004775
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004776 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4777 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4778
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004779 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
4780 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
4781 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
4782
4783 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4784 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4785 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4786 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
4787 are not case-sensitive.
4788
4789 Example :
4790 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
4791 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
4792
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004793 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
4794 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004795
4796
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004797server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004798 Declare a server in a backend
4799 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4800 no | no | yes | yes
4801 Arguments :
4802 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004803 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-server-name" is
4804 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004805
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004806 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
4807 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4808 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
4809 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02004810 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
4811 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
4812 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
4813 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
4814 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
4815 to report statistics.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004816
4817 <ports> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
4818 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
4819 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
4820 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
4821 adding this value to the client's port.
4822
4823 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
4824 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004825 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004826
4827 Examples :
4828 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
4829 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
4830
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004831 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
4832 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004833
4834
4835source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004836source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004837source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004838 Set the source address for outgoing connections
4839 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4840 yes | no | yes | yes
4841 Arguments :
4842 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
4843 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
4844 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
4845 the most appropriate address to reach its destination.
4846
4847 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
4848 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02004849 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
4850 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
4851 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004852
4853 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
4854 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
4855 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
4856 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
4857 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
4858 <addr>.
4859
4860 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
4861 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
4862 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
4863 port.
4864
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004865 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
4866 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
4867 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
4868 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
4869 and to automatically bind to the the client's IP address as seen
4870 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
4871 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
4872 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
4873 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
4874 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
4875 HTTP header.
4876
4877 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
4878 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
4879 in order to specificy which occurrence to use for the source IP
4880 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
4881 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
4882 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
4883 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
4884 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
4885 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
4886 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
4887
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004888 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
4889 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
4890 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
4891 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
4892 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
4893 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
4894
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004895 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
4896 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
4897 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
4898 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
4899
4900 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
4901 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
4902 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
4903 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
4904 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
4905 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
4906
4907 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
4908 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
4909 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
4910 there are two methods :
4911
4912 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
4913 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
4914 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
4915 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
4916 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
4917 of the client ranges may be used.
4918
4919 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
4920 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
4921 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
4922 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
4923 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
4924 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
4925 same session.
4926
4927 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
4928 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
4929 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
4930 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
4931 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
4932 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
4933
4934 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
4935 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
4936 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004937 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004938
4939 Examples :
4940 backend private
4941 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
4942 source 192.168.1.200
4943
4944 backend transparent_ssl1
4945 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
4946 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4947
4948 backend transparent_ssl2
4949 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
4950 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
4951 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
4952
4953 backend transparent_ssl3
4954 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
4955 # is more conntrack-friendly.
4956 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4957
4958 backend transparent_smtp
4959 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
4960 # with Tproxy version 4.
4961 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
4962
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004963 backend transparent_http
4964 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
4965 # proxy.
4966 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
4967
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004968 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004969 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
4970
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004971
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004972srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
4973 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
4974 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4975 yes | no | yes | yes
4976 Arguments :
4977 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
4978 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
4979 as explained at the top of this document.
4980
4981 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
4982 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
4983 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
4984 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
4985 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
4986 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
4987 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
4988
4989 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
4990 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
4991 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
4992 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
4993 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004994 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004995 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004996 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004997
4998 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
4999 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5000 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5001 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5002 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
5003 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5004
5005 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
5006 Please use "timeout server" instead.
5007
5008 See also : "timeout server", "timeout client" and "clitimeout".
5009
5010
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005011stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
5012 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
5013 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5014 no | no | yes | yes
5015
5016 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
5017 matched.
5018
5019 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
5020 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
5021
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005022 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5023 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5024 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5025
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01005026 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
5027 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
5028 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
5029 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005030
5031 Example :
5032 # statistics admin level only for localhost
5033 backend stats_localhost
5034 stats enable
5035 stats admin if LOCALHOST
5036
5037 Example :
5038 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
5039 backend stats_auth
5040 stats enable
5041 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
5042 stats admin if TRUE
5043
5044 Example :
5045 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
5046 userlist stats-auth
5047 group admin users admin
5048 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
5049 group readonly users haproxy
5050 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
5051
5052 backend stats_auth
5053 stats enable
5054 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
5055 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
5056 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
5057 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
5058
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005059 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
5060 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5061 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005062
5063
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005064stats auth <user>:<passwd>
5065 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
5066 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5067 yes | no | yes | yes
5068 Arguments :
5069 <user> is a user name to grant access to
5070
5071 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
5072
5073 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
5074 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
5075 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
5076 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
5077 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
5078 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
5079
5080 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
5081 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
5082 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005083 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005084
5085 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
5086 report using "stats scope".
5087
5088 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5089 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5090 unobvious parameters.
5091
5092 Example :
5093 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5094 backend public_www
5095 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5096 stats enable
5097 stats hide-version
5098 stats scope .
5099 stats uri /admin?stats
5100 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5101 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5102 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5103
5104 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5105 backend private_monitoring
5106 stats enable
5107 stats uri /admin?stats
5108 stats refresh 5s
5109
5110 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
5111
5112
5113stats enable
5114 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
5115 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5116 yes | no | yes | yes
5117 Arguments : none
5118
5119 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
5120 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
5121 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
5122 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
5123 - stats auth : no authentication
5124 - stats scope : no restriction
5125
5126 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5127 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5128 unobvious parameters.
5129
5130 Example :
5131 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5132 backend public_www
5133 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5134 stats enable
5135 stats hide-version
5136 stats scope .
5137 stats uri /admin?stats
5138 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5139 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5140 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5141
5142 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5143 backend private_monitoring
5144 stats enable
5145 stats uri /admin?stats
5146 stats refresh 5s
5147
5148 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5149
5150
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005151stats hide-version
5152 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005153 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5154 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005155 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005156
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005157 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
5158 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
5159 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
5160 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
5161 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
5162 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005163
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005164 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5165 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5166 unobvious parameters.
5167
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005168 Example :
5169 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5170 backend public_www
5171 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005172 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005173 stats hide-version
5174 stats scope .
5175 stats uri /admin?stats
5176 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5177 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5178 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005179
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005180 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5181 backend private_monitoring
5182 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005183 stats uri /admin?stats
5184 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01005185
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005186 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005187
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005188
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02005189stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
5190 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5191 Access control for statistics
5192
5193 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5194 no | no | yes | yes
5195
5196 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
5197 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
5198 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
5199 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
5200 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
5201 should be asked to enter a username and password.
5202
5203 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
5204 instance.
5205
5206 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5207 about ACL usage.
5208
5209
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005210stats realm <realm>
5211 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
5212 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5213 yes | no | yes | yes
5214 Arguments :
5215 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
5216 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
5217 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
5218
5219 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
5220 using a backslash ('\').
5221
5222 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
5223 only related to authentication.
5224
5225 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5226 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5227 unobvious parameters.
5228
5229 Example :
5230 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5231 backend public_www
5232 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5233 stats enable
5234 stats hide-version
5235 stats scope .
5236 stats uri /admin?stats
5237 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5238 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5239 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5240
5241 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5242 backend private_monitoring
5243 stats enable
5244 stats uri /admin?stats
5245 stats refresh 5s
5246
5247 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
5248
5249
5250stats refresh <delay>
5251 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
5252 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5253 yes | no | yes | yes
5254 Arguments :
5255 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
5256 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
5257 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
5258 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
5259 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
5260 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
5261
5262 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
5263 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
5264 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
5265 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
5266
5267 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5268 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5269 unobvious parameters.
5270
5271 Example :
5272 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5273 backend public_www
5274 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5275 stats enable
5276 stats hide-version
5277 stats scope .
5278 stats uri /admin?stats
5279 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5280 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5281 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5282
5283 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5284 backend private_monitoring
5285 stats enable
5286 stats uri /admin?stats
5287 stats refresh 5s
5288
5289 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5290
5291
5292stats scope { <name> | "." }
5293 Enable statistics and limit access scope
5294 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5295 yes | no | yes | yes
5296 Arguments :
5297 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
5298 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
5299 section in which the statement appears.
5300
5301 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
5302 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
5303 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
5304 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
5305 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
5306 exists.
5307
5308 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5309 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5310 unobvious parameters.
5311
5312 Example :
5313 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5314 backend public_www
5315 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5316 stats enable
5317 stats hide-version
5318 stats scope .
5319 stats uri /admin?stats
5320 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5321 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5322 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5323
5324 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5325 backend private_monitoring
5326 stats enable
5327 stats uri /admin?stats
5328 stats refresh 5s
5329
5330 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5331
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005332
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005333stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005334 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
5335 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5336 yes | no | yes | yes
5337
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005338 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005339 description from global section is automatically used instead.
5340
5341 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5342 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
5343
5344 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5345 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5346 unobvious parameters.
5347
5348 Example :
5349 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5350 backend private_monitoring
5351 stats enable
5352 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
5353 stats uri /admin?stats
5354 stats refresh 5s
5355
5356 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
5357 global section.
5358
5359
5360stats show-legends
5361 Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page :
5362 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
5363 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
5364 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
5365 - IP (socket, server)
5366 - cookie (backend, server)
5367
5368 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5369 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5370 unobvious parameters.
5371
5372 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
5373
5374
5375stats show-node [ <name> ]
5376 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
5377 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5378 yes | no | yes | yes
5379 Arguments:
5380 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
5381 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
5382
5383 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5384 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
5385 provided for each customer.
5386
5387 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5388 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5389 unobvious parameters.
5390
5391 Example:
5392 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5393 backend private_monitoring
5394 stats enable
5395 stats show-node Europe-1
5396 stats uri /admin?stats
5397 stats refresh 5s
5398
5399 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
5400 section.
5401
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005402
5403stats uri <prefix>
5404 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
5405 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5406 yes | no | yes | yes
5407 Arguments :
5408 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
5409 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
5410 query string.
5411
5412 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
5413 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
5414 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
5415 possible to reach it in the application.
5416
5417 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005418 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005419 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
5420 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
5421 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
5422 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
5423
5424 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
5425 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
5426 an address or a port to statistics only.
5427
5428 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5429 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5430 unobvious parameters.
5431
5432 Example :
5433 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5434 backend public_www
5435 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5436 stats enable
5437 stats hide-version
5438 stats scope .
5439 stats uri /admin?stats
5440 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5441 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5442 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5443
5444 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5445 backend private_monitoring
5446 stats enable
5447 stats uri /admin?stats
5448 stats refresh 5s
5449
5450 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
5451
5452
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005453stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
5454 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005455 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005456 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005457
5458 Arguments :
5459 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5460 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5461 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
5462 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
5463
5464 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5465 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5466 the "stick-table" statement.
5467
5468 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
5469 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
5470 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
5471 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
5472 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
5473
5474 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5475 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
5476 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
5477 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
5478 transformation rules.
5479
5480 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5481 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5482 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5483 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5484 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5485 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5486 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5487
5488 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
5489 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
5490 ACL based conditions.
5491
5492 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
5493 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
5494 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
5495 matches can be used as fallbacks.
5496
5497 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
5498 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
5499 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
5500 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
5501
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005502 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5503 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5504 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5505
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005506 Example :
5507 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5508 # last 30 minutes
5509 backend pop
5510 mode tcp
5511 balance roundrobin
5512 stick store-request src
5513 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5514 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5515 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5516
5517 backend smtp
5518 mode tcp
5519 balance roundrobin
5520 stick match src table pop
5521 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5522 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5523
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005524 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5525 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005526
5527
5528stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5529 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
5530 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5531 no | no | yes | yes
5532
5533 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
5534 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
5535 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
5536 for writing more maintainable configurations.
5537
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005538 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5539 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5540 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5541
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005542 Examples :
5543 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01005544 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005545
5546 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
5547 stick match src table pop if !localhost
5548 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
5549
5550
5551 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
5552 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
5553 backend http
5554 mode http
5555 balance roundrobin
5556 stick on src table https
5557 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
5558 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
5559 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
5560
5561 backend https
5562 mode tcp
5563 balance roundrobin
5564 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5565 stick on src
5566 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5567 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5568
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005569 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005570
5571
5572stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5573 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5574 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5575 no | no | yes | yes
5576
5577 Arguments :
5578 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5579 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5580 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5581 server is selected.
5582
5583 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5584 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5585 the "stick-table" statement.
5586
5587 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5588 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5589 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
5590 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
5591 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
5592 address.
5593
5594 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5595 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
5596 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
5597 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
5598 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
5599 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
5600 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
5601 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
5602 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
5603 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
5604
5605 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5606 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5607 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5608 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5609 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5610 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5611 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5612
5613 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
5614 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5615 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
5616 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5617
5618 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
5619 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5620 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5621 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5622 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5623 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5624 another protocol or access method.
5625
5626 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
5627 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
5628 the request.
5629
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005630 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5631 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5632 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5633
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005634 Example :
5635 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5636 # last 30 minutes
5637 backend pop
5638 mode tcp
5639 balance roundrobin
5640 stick store-request src
5641 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5642 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5643 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5644
5645 backend smtp
5646 mode tcp
5647 balance roundrobin
5648 stick match src table pop
5649 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5650 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5651
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005652 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5653 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005654
5655
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005656stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005657 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
5658 [store <data_type>]*
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005659 Configure the stickiness table for the current backend
5660 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005661 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005662
5663 Arguments :
5664 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
5665 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
5666 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5667 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5668
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01005669 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
5670 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
5671 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5672 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5673
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005674 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
5675 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
5676 instance.
5677
5678 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
5679 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
5680 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5681 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
5682 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
5683 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005684 to 32 characters.
5685
5686 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
5687 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
5688 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5689 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
5690 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
5691 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005692
5693 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005694 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
5695 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005696 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
5697 increase.
5698
5699 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005700 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
5701 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
5702 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005703
5704 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
5705 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
5706 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
5707 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
5708 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
5709 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
5710 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
5711 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
5712 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
5713 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
5714 parameter (see below).
5715
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005716 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
5717 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
5718 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
5719 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
5720 soft restart.
5721
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005722 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
5723
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005724 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
5725 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
5726 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
5727 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
5728 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
5729 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
5730 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
5731 if not expiration delay is specified.
5732
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005733 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
5734 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
5735 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
5736 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005737 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
5738 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
5739 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
5740 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
5741 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
5742 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
5743 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
5744 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
5745 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
5746 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
5747 types and their arguments.
5748
5749 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
5750 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
5751 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
5752 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
5753
5754 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
5755 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
5756 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
5757 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
5758
5759 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5760 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
5761 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
5762 they were received.
5763
5764 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5765 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
5766 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
5767 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
5768 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
5769
5770 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5771 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5772 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5773 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
5774 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5775
5776 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5777 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
5778 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
5779
5780 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5781 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5782 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5783 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
5784 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5785
5786 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5787 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
5788 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
5789 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
5790 the client side.
5791
5792 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5793 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5794 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5795 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
5796 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
5797 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
5798 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
5799
5800 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5801 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
5802 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
5803 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
5804 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
5805 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
5806 (eg: vulnerability scan).
5807
5808 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5809 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5810 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5811 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
5812 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
5813 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5814
5815 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5816 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
5817 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
5818 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
5819
5820 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5821 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5822 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5823 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5824 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5825 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
5826 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
5827 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
5828 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
5829 recommended for better fairness.
5830
5831 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5832 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
5833 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
5834 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
5835
5836 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
5837 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5838 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5839 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5840 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5841 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
5842 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
5843 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
5844 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
5845 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005846
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005847 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
5848 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005849 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
5850 reference it.
5851
5852 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
5853 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
5854 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
5855 as an exclusive stickiness.
5856
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005857 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
5858 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
5859 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
5860 something that can be ignored.
5861
5862 Example:
5863 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
5864 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
5865 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
5866 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
5867
5868 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01005869 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005870
5871
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005872stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5873 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5874 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5875 no | no | yes | yes
5876
5877 Arguments :
5878 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5879 describes what elements of the response or connection will
5880 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5881 server is selected.
5882
5883 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5884 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5885 the "stick-table" statement.
5886
5887 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5888 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5889 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
5890 when the response is a SSL server hello.
5891
5892 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5893 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
5894 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
5895 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
5896 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
5897 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
5898 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
5899 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
5900 rules.
5901
5902 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5903 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5904 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5905 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5906 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5907 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5908 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5909
5910 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
5911 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5912 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
5913 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5914
5915 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
5916 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5917 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5918 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5919 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5920 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5921 another protocol or access method.
5922
5923 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
5924
5925 Example :
5926 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
5927 backend https
5928 mode tcp
5929 balance roundrobin
5930 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
5931 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
5932
5933 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
5934 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
5935
5936 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
5937 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5938 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
5939
5940 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
5941 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
5942
5943 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
5944 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
5945 # at offset 44.
5946
5947 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
5948 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
5949
5950 # Learn on response if server hello.
5951 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
5952
5953 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5954 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5955
5956 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
5957 extraction.
5958
5959
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005960tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5961 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005962 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5963 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005964 Arguments :
5965 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
5966 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
5967 See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005968
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005969 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005970
5971 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
5972 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005973 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
5974 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
5975 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
5976 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
5977 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
5978 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005979
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005980 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
5981 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
5982 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
5983 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005984
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005985 Three types of actions are supported :
5986 - accept :
5987 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
5988 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
5989 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005990
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005991 - reject :
5992 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
5993 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
5994 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
5995 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
5996 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
5997 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
5998 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
5999 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
6000 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
6001 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
6002 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
6003 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006004
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006005 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
6006 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
6007 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
6008 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
6009 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
6010 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
6011 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
6012 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
6013 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006014
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006015 These actions take one or two arguments :
6016 <key> is mandatory, and defines the criterion the tracking key will
6017 be derived from. At the moment, only "src" is supported. With
6018 it, the key will be the connection's source IPv4 address.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006019
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006020 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
6021 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
6022 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
6023 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006024
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006025 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
6026 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
6027 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
6028 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
6029 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
6030 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
6031 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
6032 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
6033 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
6034 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006035
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006036 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6037 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6038 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006039
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006040 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
6041 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
6042 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006043
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006044 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006045 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006046 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006047
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006048 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
6049 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
6050 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006051
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006052 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
6053 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6054 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006055
6056 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6057
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006058 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006059
6060
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006061tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6062 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006063 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006064 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006065 Arguments :
6066 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6067 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
6068 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006069
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006070 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006071
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006072 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
6073 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6074 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
6075 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
6076 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006077
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006078 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
6079 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
6080 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
6081 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
6082 both frontends and backends. In frontends, they will be evaluated upon new
6083 connections. In backends, they will be evaluated once a session is assigned
6084 a backend. This means that a single frontend connection may be evaluated
6085 several times by one or multiple backends when a session gets reassigned
6086 (for instance after a client-side HTTP keep-alive request).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006087
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006088 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6089 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6090 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6091 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006092
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006093 Three types of actions are supported :
6094 - accept :
6095 - reject :
6096 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006097
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006098 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
6099 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006100
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006101 Also, it is worth noting that if sticky counters are tracked from a rule
6102 defined in a backend, this tracking will automatically end when the session
6103 releases the backend. That allows per-backend counter tracking even in case
6104 of HTTP keep-alive requests when the backend changes. While there is nothing
6105 mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the track-sc1 pointer to track
6106 per-frontend counters and track-sc2 to track per-backend counters.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006107
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006108 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006109 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6110 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006111
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006112 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
6113 rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full request has been
6114 buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this, the
6115 best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
6116 period.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006117
6118 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006119 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
6120 # and reject everything else.
6121 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
6122 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6123 tcp-request content accept if HTTP is_host_com
6124 tcp-request content reject
6125
6126 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006127 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
6128 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6129 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006130 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006131
6132 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
6133 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6134 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006135 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006136 tcp-request content reject
6137
6138 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
6139 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
6140
6141 frontend http
6142 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC1 as a global abuse counter
6143 # protecting all our sites
6144 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
6145 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6146 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
6147 ...
6148 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
6149
6150 backend http_dynamic
6151 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
6152 # by SC2), block it globally in the frontend.
6153 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
6154 acl click_too_fast sc2_http_req_rate gt 10
6155 acl mark_as_abuser sc1_inc_gpc0
6156 tcp-request content track-sc2 src
6157 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006158
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006159 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006160
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006161 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006162
6163
6164tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
6165 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
6166 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006167 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006168 Arguments :
6169 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6170 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6171 as explained at the top of this document.
6172
6173 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
6174 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
6175 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
6176 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
6177 data for at most the specified amount of time.
6178
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006179 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
6180 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
6181 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
6182 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
6183
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006184 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
6185 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006186 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006187 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01006188 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
6189 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
6190 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
6191 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006192
6193 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
6194 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
6195 it pass through unaffected.
6196
6197 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
6198 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
6199 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006200 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006201 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
6202 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02006203 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
6204 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
6205 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006206
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006207 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006208 "timeout client".
6209
6210
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006211tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6212 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
6213 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6214 no | no | yes | yes
6215 Arguments :
6216 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6217 actions include : "accept", "reject".
6218 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
6219
6220 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
6221
6222 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
6223 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6224 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
6225 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection delay is
6226 set and expires with no matching rule.
6227
6228 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
6229
6230 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6231 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6232 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6233 inserted.
6234
6235 Two types of actions are supported :
6236 - accept :
6237 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6238 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6239 the rules evaluation.
6240
6241 - reject :
6242 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6243 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6244 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediatly closed.
6245
6246 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6247 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6248 for changing the default action to a reject.
6249
6250 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-reponse content"
6251 rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has been
6252 buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this, the
6253 best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
6254 period.
6255
6256 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6257
6258 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
6259
6260
6261tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
6262 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
6263 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6264 no | no | yes | yes
6265 Arguments :
6266 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6267 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6268 as explained at the top of this document.
6269
6270 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
6271
6272
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006273timeout check <timeout>
6274 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
6275 established.
6276
6277 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6278 yes | no | yes | yes
6279 Arguments:
6280 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6281 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6282 as explained at the top of this document.
6283
6284 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
6285 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
6286 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
6287 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01006288 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
6289 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
6290 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006291
6292 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
6293 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
6294
6295 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
6296 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006297 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006298
6299 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6300 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6301 forget about it.
6302
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006303 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
6304 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006305
6306
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006307timeout client <timeout>
6308timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6309 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
6310 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6311 yes | yes | yes | no
6312 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006313 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006314 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6315 as explained at the top of this document.
6316
6317 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
6318 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6319 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
6320 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
6321 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
6322 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
6323 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
6324 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006325 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006326 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
6327 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
6328
6329 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
6330 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6331 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6332 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6333 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6334 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6335
6336 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
6337 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
6338 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6339
6340 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server".
6341
6342
6343timeout connect <timeout>
6344timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6345 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
6346 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6347 yes | no | yes | yes
6348 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006349 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006350 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6351 as explained at the top of this document.
6352
6353 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006354 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006355 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006356 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006357 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
6358 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006359
6360 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6361 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6362 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6363 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6364 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
6365 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6366
6367 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
6368 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
6369 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6370
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006371 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
6372 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006373
6374
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006375timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
6376 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
6377 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6378 yes | yes | yes | yes
6379 Arguments :
6380 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6381 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6382 as explained at the top of this document.
6383
6384 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
6385 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
6386 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
6387 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
6388 once the request has started to present itself.
6389
6390 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
6391 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
6392 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
6393 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
6394 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
6395
6396 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
6397 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
6398 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
6399 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
6400
6401 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
6402 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
6403 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
6404 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
6405 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02006406 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006407
6408 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
6409 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
6410 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
6411 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
6412
6413 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
6414
6415
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006416timeout http-request <timeout>
6417 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
6418 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006419 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006420 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006421 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006422 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6423 as explained at the top of this document.
6424
6425 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
6426 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
6427 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
6428 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
6429 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
6430 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
6431 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
6432 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
6433
6434 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
6435 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006436 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
6437 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006438
6439 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
6440 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
6441 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
6442 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
6443 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
6444
6445 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006446 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
6447 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
6448 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006449
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006450 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006451
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006452
6453timeout queue <timeout>
6454 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
6455 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6456 yes | no | yes | yes
6457 Arguments :
6458 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6459 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6460 as explained at the top of this document.
6461
6462 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
6463 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
6464 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
6465 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
6466 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
6467
6468 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
6469 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
6470 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
6471 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
6472
6473 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6474
6475
6476timeout server <timeout>
6477timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6478 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6479 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6480 yes | no | yes | yes
6481 Arguments :
6482 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6483 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6484 as explained at the top of this document.
6485
6486 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6487 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6488 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6489 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6490 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6491 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6492 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6493
6494 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6495 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6496 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6497 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6498 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006499 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006500 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006501 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006502
6503 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6504 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6505 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6506 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6507 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6508 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6509
6510 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
6511 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
6512 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6513
6514 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client".
6515
6516
6517timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006518 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006519 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6520 yes | yes | yes | yes
6521 Arguments :
6522 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
6523 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6524 as explained at the top of this document.
6525
6526 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
6527 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
6528 defines how long it will be maintained open.
6529
6530 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6531 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6532 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
6533 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006534 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006535
6536 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6537
6538
6539transparent (deprecated)
6540 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6541 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006542 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006543 Arguments : none
6544
6545 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
6546 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6547 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6548 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6549 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6550 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6551 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6552 appropriate server.
6553
6554 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
6555
6556 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6557 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6558
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006559 See also: "option transparent"
6560
6561
6562use_backend <backend> if <condition>
6563use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006564 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006565 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6566 no | yes | yes | no
6567 Arguments :
6568 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section.
6569
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006570 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006571
6572 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
6573 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
6574 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006575 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
6576 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
6577 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
6578 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006579
6580 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
6581 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
6582 assign the backend.
6583
6584 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
6585 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6586 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
6587 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
6588 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
6589 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
6590
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006591 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006592 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006593 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
6594 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
6595 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
6596
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006597 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006598
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006599
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010066005. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006601------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006602
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01006603The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
6604which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
6605arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
6606settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
6607after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
6608Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
6609address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006610
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006611 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01006612 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006613
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006614The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006615
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006616addr <ipv4>
6617 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
6618 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
6619 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
6620 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
6621 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006622
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006623 Supported in default-server: No
6624
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006625backup
6626 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
6627 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
6628 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
6629 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
6630 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
6631 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006632
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006633 Supported in default-server: No
6634
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006635check
6636 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01006637 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
6638 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
6639 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
6640 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
6641 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
6642 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
6643 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
6644 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
6645 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
6646 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006647
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006648 Supported in default-server: No
6649
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006650cookie <value>
6651 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
6652 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
6653 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
6654 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
6655 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
6656 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
6657 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
6658
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006659 Supported in default-server: No
6660
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02006661disabled
6662 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
6663 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
6664 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
6665 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
6666 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
6667
6668 Supported in default-server: No
6669
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006670error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006671 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
6672 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
6673 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006674
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006675 Supported in default-server: Yes
6676
6677 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006678
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006679fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006680 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
6681 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
6682 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
6683
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006684 Supported in default-server: Yes
6685
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006686id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006687 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
6688 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
6689 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006690
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006691 Supported in default-server: No
6692
6693inter <delay>
6694fastinter <delay>
6695downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006696 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
6697 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
6698 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
6699 between checks depending on the server state :
6700
6701 Server state | Interval used
6702 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6703 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
6704 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6705 Transitionally UP (going down), |
6706 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
6707 or yet unchecked. |
6708 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6709 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
6710 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006711
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006712 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
6713 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
6714 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
6715 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
6716 hosted on the same hardware, the health-checks of all servers are started
6717 with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to add some random
6718 noise in the health checks interval using the global "spread-checks"
6719 keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot of backends use the same
6720 servers.
6721
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006722 Supported in default-server: Yes
6723
6724maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006725 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
6726 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
6727 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
6728 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
6729 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
6730 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
6731 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
6732 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
6733
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006734 Supported in default-server: Yes
6735
6736maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006737 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
6738 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
6739 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
6740 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
6741 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
6742 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
6743 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
6744
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006745 Supported in default-server: Yes
6746
6747minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006748 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
6749 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
6750 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
6751 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
6752 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
6753 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006754 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006755 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006756
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006757 Supported in default-server: Yes
6758
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09006759non-stick
6760 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
6761 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
6762 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
6763
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006764observe <mode>
6765 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
6766 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
6767 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
6768 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
6769 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
6770 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01006771 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006772
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006773 Supported in default-server: No
6774
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006775 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
6776
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006777on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006778 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
6779 Currently, four modes are available:
6780 - fastinter: force fastinter
6781 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
6782 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
6783 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
6784 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
6785
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006786 Supported in default-server: Yes
6787
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006788 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
6789
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09006790on-marked-down <action>
6791 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
6792 Currently one action is available:
6793 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions
6794
6795 Actions are disabled by default
6796
6797 Supported in default-server: Yes
6798
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006799port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006800 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
6801 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
6802 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
6803 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
6804 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
6805 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
6806
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006807 Supported in default-server: Yes
6808
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006809redir <prefix>
6810 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
6811 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
6812 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
6813 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
6814 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
6815 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
6816 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
6817 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006818 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006819 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
6820 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
6821 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
6822 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
6823 loop between the client and HAProxy!
6824
6825 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
6826
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006827 Supported in default-server: No
6828
6829rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006830 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
6831 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
6832 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
6833
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006834 Supported in default-server: Yes
6835
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01006836send-proxy
6837 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
6838 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
6839 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
6840 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
6841 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
6842 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
6843 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
6844 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
6845 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
6846 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. See also the "accept-proxy"
6847 option of the "bind" keyword.
6848
6849 Supported in default-server: No
6850
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006851slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006852 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
6853 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
6854 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
6855 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
6856 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
6857 parameters :
6858
6859 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
6860 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
6861
6862 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
6863 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
6864 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
6865 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
6866
6867 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
6868 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
6869 seen as failed.
6870
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006871 Supported in default-server: Yes
6872
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006873source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006874source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006875source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006876 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
6877 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
6878 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
6879 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
6880
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006881 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
6882 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
6883 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
6884 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
6885 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
6886 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
6887 server.
6888
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006889 Supported in default-server: No
6890
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006891track [<proxy>/]<server>
6892 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
6893 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
6894 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
6895 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
6896 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
6897
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006898 Supported in default-server: No
6899
6900weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006901 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
6902 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
6903 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02006904 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
6905 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
6906 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
6907 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
6908 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
6909 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006910
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006911 Supported in default-server: Yes
6912
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006913
69146. HTTP header manipulation
6915---------------------------
6916
6917In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
6918response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
6919request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
6920which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
6921against information leak from the internal network. But there is a limitation
6922to this : since HAProxy's HTTP engine does not support keep-alive, only headers
6923passed during the first request of a TCP session will be seen. All subsequent
6924headers will be considered data only and not analyzed. Furthermore, HAProxy
6925never touches data contents, it stops analysis at the end of headers.
6926
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02006927There is an exception though. If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response"
6928(status code 1xx), it is able to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny,
6929rewrite or delete a header, but it will refuse to add a header to any such
6930messages as this is not HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers
6931in such responses is to stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006932happen, for instance because another downstream equipment would unconditionally
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02006933add a header, or if a server name appears there. When such messages are seen,
6934normal processing still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
6935
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006936This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
6937in section 4.2 :
6938
6939 - reqadd <string>
6940 - reqallow <search>
6941 - reqiallow <search>
6942 - reqdel <search>
6943 - reqidel <search>
6944 - reqdeny <search>
6945 - reqideny <search>
6946 - reqpass <search>
6947 - reqipass <search>
6948 - reqrep <search> <replace>
6949 - reqirep <search> <replace>
6950 - reqtarpit <search>
6951 - reqitarpit <search>
6952 - rspadd <string>
6953 - rspdel <search>
6954 - rspidel <search>
6955 - rspdeny <search>
6956 - rspideny <search>
6957 - rsprep <search> <replace>
6958 - rspirep <search> <replace>
6959
6960With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
6961is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
6962parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
6963prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
6964Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
6965
6966 \t for a tab
6967 \r for a carriage return (CR)
6968 \n for a new line (LF)
6969 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
6970 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
6971 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
6972 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
6973 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
6974
6975The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
6976portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
6977above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
6978regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
69799 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
6980is very common to users of the "sed" program.
6981
6982The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
6983after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
6984
6985Notes related to these keywords :
6986---------------------------------
6987 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
6988 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
6989 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
6990
6991 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
6992 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
6993 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
6994
6995 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
6996 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
6997 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
6998 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
6999 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
7000
7001 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
7002 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
7003 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
7004 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
7005 useless headers before adding new ones.
7006
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007007 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007008 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
7009
7010 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
7011 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
7012 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
7013
7014 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
7015 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007016 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007017
7018
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010070197. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
7020------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007021
7022The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
7023content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
7024from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
7025simple :
7026
7027 - define test criteria with sets of values
7028 - perform actions only if a set of tests is valid
7029
7030The actions generally consist in blocking the request, or selecting a backend.
7031
7032In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
7033
7034 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
7035
7036This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
7037Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
7038and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
7039an operator which may be specified before the set of values. The values are
7040of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
7041
7042ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
7043'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
7044which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
7045
7046There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
7047performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
7048
7049The following ACL flags are currently supported :
7050
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007051 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
7052 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007053 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
7054
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007055The "-f" flag is special as it loads all of the lines it finds in the file
7056specified in argument and loads all of them before continuing. It is even
7057possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments if the patterns are to be loaded from
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02007058multiple files. Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will
7059be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs will be stripped. If it is absolutely
7060needed to insert a valid pattern beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a
7061space so that it is not taken for a comment. Depending on the data type and
7062match method, haproxy may load the lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast
7063lookups. This is true for IPv4 and exact string matching. In this case,
7064duplicates will automatically be removed. Also, note that the "-i" flag applies
7065to subsequent entries and not to entries loaded from files preceeding it. For
7066instance :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007067
7068 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
7069
7070In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
7071the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
7072case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
7073too.
7074
7075Note that right now it is difficult for the ACL parsers to report errors, so if
7076a file is unreadable or unparsable, the most you'll get is a parse error in the
7077ACL. Thus, file-based ACLs should only be produced by reliable processes.
7078
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007079Supported types of values are :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007080
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007081 - integers or integer ranges
7082 - strings
7083 - regular expressions
7084 - IP addresses and networks
7085
7086
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070877.1. Matching integers
7088----------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007089
7090Matching integers is special in that ranges and operators are permitted. Note
7091that integer matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value
7092expressed with a lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which
7093may be omitted.
7094
7095For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
7096unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
7097representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
7098
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007099As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
7100two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
7101instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
7102ranges and operators.
7103
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007104For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007105operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
7106Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
7107of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007108
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007109Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007110
7111 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
7112 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
7113 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
7114 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
7115 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
7116
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007117For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007118
7119 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
7120
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007121This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
7122
7123 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
7124
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007125
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020071267.2. Matching strings
7127---------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007128
7129String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
7130exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
7131characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
7132string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
7133to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007134before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007135
7136
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020071377.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
7138-------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007139
7140Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
7141they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
7142possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
7143passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
7144the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007145the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
7146match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007147
7148
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020071497.4. Matching IPv4 addresses
7150----------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007151
7152IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
7153netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
7154within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007155host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007156difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
7157at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
7158does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
7159parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007160
7161
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020071627.5. Available matching criteria
7163--------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007164
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020071657.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
7166------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007167
7168A first set of criteria applies to information which does not require any
7169analysis of the request or response contents. Those generally include TCP/IP
7170addresses and ports, as well as internal values independant on the stream.
7171
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007172always_false
7173 This one never matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7174 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7175
7176always_true
7177 This one always matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7178 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7179
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007180avg_queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007181avg_queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007182 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
7183 divided by the number of active servers. This is very similar to "queue"
7184 except that the size of the farm is considered, in order to give a more
7185 accurate measurement of the time it may take for a new connection to be
7186 processed. The main usage is to return a sorry page to new users when it
7187 becomes certain they will get a degraded service. Note that in the event
7188 there would not be any active server anymore, we would consider twice the
7189 number of queued connections as the measured value. This is a fair estimate,
7190 as we expect one server to get back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send
7191 new traffic to another backend if in better shape. See also the "queue",
7192 "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01007193
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007194be_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007195be_conn(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007196 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
7197 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
7198 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7199 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
7200 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007201
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01007202be_id <integer>
7203 Applies to the backend's id. Can be used in frontends to check from which
7204 backend it was called.
7205
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007206be_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007207be_sess_rate(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007208 Returns true when the sessions creation rate on the backend matches the
7209 specified values or ranges, in number of new sessions per second. This is
7210 used to switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one
7211 reaches too high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent
7212 sucking of an online dictionary).
7213
7214 Example :
7215 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
7216 backend dynamic
7217 mode http
7218 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
7219 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007220
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007221connslots <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007222connslots(<backend>) <integer>
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007223 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007224 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007225 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
7226
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007227 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
7228 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007229
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007230 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007231 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
7232 multiple backends (perhaps using acls to do name-based load balancing) and
7233 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
7234 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
7235 actually *down*, this acl is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007236 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007237
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007238 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
7239 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
7240 then this acl clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
7241 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007242
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007243dst <ip_address>
7244 Applies to the local IPv4 address the client connected to. It can be used to
7245 switch to a different backend for some alternative addresses.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007246
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007247dst_conn <integer>
7248 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the same socket
7249 including the one being evaluated. It can be used to either return a sorry
7250 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
7251 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
7252 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
7253 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" criteria.
7254
7255dst_port <integer>
7256 Applies to the local port the client connected to. It can be used to switch
7257 to a different backend for some alternative ports.
7258
7259fe_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007260fe_conn(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007261 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
7262 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
7263 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7264 frontend. It can be used to either return a sorry page before hard-blocking,
7265 or to use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is
7266 considered saturated. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn" and "fe_sess_rate"
7267 criteria.
7268
7269fe_id <integer>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007270 Applies to the frontend's id. Can be used in backends to check from which
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007271 frontend it was called.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007272
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007273fe_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007274fe_sess_rate(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007275 Returns true when the session creation rate on the current or the named
7276 frontend matches the specified values or ranges, expressed in new sessions
7277 per second. This is used to limit the connection rate to acceptable ranges in
7278 order to prevent abuse of service at the earliest moment. This can be
7279 combined with layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for
7280 the rate to go down below the limit.
7281
7282 Example :
7283 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
7284 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
7285 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
7286 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
7287 frontend mail
7288 bind :25
7289 mode tcp
7290 maxconn 100
7291 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
7292 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
7293 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
7294 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007295
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007296nbsrv <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007297nbsrv(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007298 Returns true when the number of usable servers of either the current backend
7299 or the named backend matches the values or ranges specified. This is used to
7300 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
7301 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
7302 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007303
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007304queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007305queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007306 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
7307 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
7308 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
7309 one. This can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level,
7310 generally indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers.
7311 One possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones.
7312 See also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
7313
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007314sc1_bytes_in_rate
7315sc2_bytes_in_rate
7316 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
7317 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
7318 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
7319
7320sc1_bytes_out_rate
7321sc2_bytes_out_rate
7322 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
7323 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
7324 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
7325
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02007326sc1_clr_gpc0
7327sc2_clr_gpc0
7328 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
7329 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
7330 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. The test
7331 can also be used alone and always returns true. This is typically used as a
7332 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
7333 was verified :
7334
7335 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
7336 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
7337 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7338 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0 gt 5
7339 acl save sc1_clr_gpc0
7340 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
7341 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7342
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007343sc1_conn_cnt
7344sc2_conn_cnt
7345 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
7346 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
7347
7348sc1_conn_cur
7349sc2_conn_cur
7350 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
7351 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
7352 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
7353
7354sc1_conn_rate
7355sc2_conn_rate
7356 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
7357 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
7358 See also src_conn_rate.
7359
7360sc1_get_gpc0
7361sc2_get_gpc0
7362 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
7363 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
7364
7365sc1_http_err_cnt
7366sc2_http_err_cnt
7367 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
7368 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
7369 See also src_http_err_cnt.
7370
7371sc1_http_err_rate
7372sc2_http_err_rate
7373 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
7374 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
7375 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
7376 src_http_err_rate.
7377
7378sc1_http_req_cnt
7379sc2_http_req_cnt
7380 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
7381 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
7382 src_http_req_cnt.
7383
7384sc1_http_req_rate
7385sc2_http_req_rate
7386 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
7387 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
7388 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
7389 src_http_req_rate.
7390
7391sc1_inc_gpc0
7392sc2_inc_gpc0
7393 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
7394 tracked counters, and returns its value. Before the first invocation, the
7395 stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
7396 return 1. The test can also be used alone and always returns true. This is
7397 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
7398 when a first ACL was verified :
7399
7400 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7401 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0
7402 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7403
7404sc1_kbytes_in
7405sc2_kbytes_in
7406 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
7407 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
7408 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
7409 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
7410
7411sc1_kbytes_out
7412sc2_kbytes_out
7413 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
7414 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
7415 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
7416 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
7417
7418sc1_sess_cnt
7419sc2_sess_cnt
7420 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
7421 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
7422 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
7423 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
7424 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performend over the connection
7425 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
7426
7427sc1_sess_rate
7428sc2_sess_rate
7429 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
7430 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
7431 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
7432 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
7433 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
7434 performend over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
7435
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007436so_id <integer>
7437 Applies to the socket's id. Useful in frontends with many bind keywords.
7438
7439src <ip_address>
7440 Applies to the client's IPv4 address. It is usually used to limit access to
7441 certain resources such as statistics. Note that it is the TCP-level source
7442 address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a proxy.
7443
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007444src_bytes_in_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007445src_bytes_in_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007446 Returns the average bytes rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
7447 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7448 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007449 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007450
7451src_bytes_out_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007452src_bytes_out_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007453 Returns the average bytes rate to the connection's source IPv4 address in the
7454 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7455 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007456 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007457
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02007458src_clr_gpc0 <integer>
7459src_clr_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
7460 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
7461 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7462 stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not found, an
7463 entry is created and 0 is returned. The test can also be used alone and
7464 always returns true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression
7465 in order to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
7466
7467 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
7468 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
7469 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
7470 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
7471 acl save src_clr_gpc0
7472 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
7473 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7474
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007475src_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007476src_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007477 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
7478 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
7479 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007480 See also sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007481
7482src_conn_cur <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007483src_conn_cur(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007484 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
7485 current connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table
7486 or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007487 returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007488
7489src_conn_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007490src_conn_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007491 Returns the average connection rate from the connection's source IPv4 address
7492 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7493 in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007494 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007495
7496src_get_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007497src_get_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007498 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
7499 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
7500 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007501 See also sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007502
7503src_http_err_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007504src_http_err_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007505 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the current connection's
7506 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7507 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007508 If the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007509
7510src_http_err_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007511src_http_err_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007512 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the current connection's source
7513 IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
7514 table, measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table.
7515 This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007516 is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007517
7518src_http_req_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007519src_http_req_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007520 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the current connection's
7521 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7522 stick-table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007523 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007524
7525src_http_req_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007526src_http_req_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007527 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the current connection's
7528 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7529 stick-table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
7530 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007531 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007532
7533src_inc_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007534src_inc_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007535 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
7536 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7537 stick-table, and returns its value. If the address is not found, an entry is
7538 created and 1 is returned. The test can also be used alone and always returns
7539 true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to
7540 mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
7541
7542 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
7543 acl kill src_inc_gpc0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007544 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007545
7546src_kbytes_in <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007547src_kbytes_in(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007548 Returns the amount of data received from the connection's source IPv4 address
7549 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7550 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
7551 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007552 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007553
7554src_kbytes_out <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007555src_kbytes_out(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007556 Returns the amount of data sent to the connection's source IPv4 address in
7557 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7558 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
7559 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007560 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007561
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007562src_port <integer>
7563 Applies to the client's TCP source port. This has a very limited usage.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007564
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007565src_sess_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007566src_sess_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007567 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
7568 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
7569 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
7570 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007571 is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007572
7573src_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007574src_sess_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007575 Returns the average session rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
7576 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7577 amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A session is a
7578 connection that got past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007579 found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007580
7581src_updt_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007582src_updt_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007583 Creates or updates the entry associated to the source IPv4 address in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007584 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table. This table
7585 must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise the match
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007586 will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the expiration
7587 timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match can't return
7588 zero. This is used to reject service abusers based on their source address.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007589 Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-counters" instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007590
7591 Example :
7592 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
7593 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
7594 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
7595 listen ssh
7596 bind :22
7597 mode tcp
7598 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007599 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007600 tcp-request content reject if { src_update_count gt 3 }
7601 server local 127.0.0.1:22
7602
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007603srv_conn(<backend>/<server>) <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +02007604 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the server,
7605 possibly including the connection being evaluated.
7606 It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is full.
7607 See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" criteria.
7608
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01007609srv_id <integer>
7610 Applies to the server's id. Can be used in frontends or backends.
7611
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +02007612srv_is_up(<server>)
7613srv_is_up(<backend>/<server>)
7614 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
7615 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
7616 looked up in the current backend. The function takes no arguments since it
7617 is used as a boolean. It is mainly used to take action based on an external
7618 status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's availability).
7619 Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in using dummy servers
7620 as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from the CLI, so that
7621 rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
7622
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02007623table_avl <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007624table_avl(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02007625 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
7626 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
7627
7628table_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007629table_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02007630 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
7631 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
7632 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
7633
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007634
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020076357.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4 (also called Layer 6)
7636---------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007637
7638A second set of criteria depends on data found in buffers, but which can change
7639during analysis. This requires that some data has been buffered, for instance
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007640through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request content"
7641keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007642
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01007643rep_ssl_hello_type <integer>
7644 Returns true when data in the response buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
7645 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
7646 This test was designed to be used with TCP response content inspection: a
7647 SSL session ID may be fetched.
7648
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007649req_len <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007650 Returns true when the length of the data in the request buffer matches the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007651 specified range. It is important to understand that this test does not
7652 return false as long as the buffer is changing. This means that a check with
7653 equality to zero will almost always immediately match at the beginning of the
7654 session, while a test for more data will wait for that data to come in and
7655 return false only when haproxy is certain that no more data will come in.
7656 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection.
7657
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007658req_proto_http
7659 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
7660 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007661 is used so there should be no surprises. This test can be used for instance
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007662 to direct HTTP traffic to a given port and HTTPS traffic to another one
7663 using TCP request content inspection rules.
7664
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007665req_rdp_cookie <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007666req_rdp_cookie(<name>) <string>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007667 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol, and
7668 a cookie is present and equal to <string>. By default, any cookie name is
7669 checked, but a specific cookie name can be specified in parenthesis. The
7670 parser only checks for the first cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol
7671 specification. The cookie name is case insensitive. This ACL can be useful
7672 with the "MSTS" cookie, as it can contain the user name of the client
7673 connecting to the server if properly configured on the client. This can be
7674 used to restrict access to certain servers to certain users.
7675
7676req_rdp_cookie_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007677req_rdp_cookie_cnt(<name>) <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007678 Returns true when the data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol
7679 and the number of RDP cookies matches the specified range (typically zero or
7680 one). Optionally a specific cookie name can be checked. This is a simple way
7681 of detecting the RDP protocol, as clients generally send the MSTS or MSTSHASH
7682 cookies.
7683
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01007684req_ssl_hello_type <integer>
7685 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
7686 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
7687 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection: an
7688 SSL session ID may be fetched.
7689
7690req_ssl_sni <string>
7691 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
7692 or superior) client hello message with a Server Name Indication TLS extension
7693 (SNI) matching <string>. SNI normally contains the name of the host the
7694 client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing
7695 or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This
7696 test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection. If content
7697 switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait for a complete client
7698 hello (type 1), like in the example below.
7699
7700 Examples :
7701 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
7702 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7703 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
7704 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
7705 default_backend bk_sorry_page
7706
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007707req_ssl_ver <decimal>
7708 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like SSL, with a protocol
7709 version matching the specified range. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
7710 messages are supported. The test tries to be strict enough to avoid being
7711 easily fooled. In particular, it waits for as many bytes as announced in the
7712 message header if this header looks valid (bound to the buffer size). Note
7713 that TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. This test was designed to be used
7714 with TCP request content inspection.
7715
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02007716wait_end
7717 Waits for the end of the analysis period to return true. This may be used in
7718 conjunction with content analysis to avoid returning a wrong verdict early.
7719 It may also be used to delay some actions, such as a delayed reject for some
7720 special addresses. Since it either stops the rules evaluation or immediately
7721 returns true, it is recommended to use this acl as the last one in a rule.
7722 Please note that the default ACL "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior
7723 declaration. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
7724 inspection.
7725
7726 Examples :
7727 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
7728 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
7729 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
7730
7731 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
7732 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
7733 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
7734 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
7735 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
7736 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
7737 tcp-request content reject
7738
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007739
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020077407.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
7741--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007742
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007743A third set of criteria applies to information which can be found at the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007744application layer (layer 7). Those require that a full HTTP request has been
7745read, and are only evaluated then. They may require slightly more CPU resources
7746than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and response are indexed.
7747
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007748hdr <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007749hdr(<header>) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007750 Note: all the "hdr*" matching criteria either apply to all headers, or to a
7751 particular header whose name is passed between parenthesis and without any
7752 space. The header name is not case-sensitive. The header matching complies
7753 with RFC2616, and treats as separate headers all values delimited by commas.
7754 Use the shdr() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7755
7756 The "hdr" criteria returns true if any of the headers matching the criteria
7757 match any of the strings. This can be used to check exact for values. For
7758 instance, checking that "connection: close" is set :
7759
7760 hdr(Connection) -i close
7761
7762hdr_beg <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007763hdr_beg(<header>) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007764 Returns true when one of the headers begins with one of the strings. See
7765 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_beg() variant for
7766 response headers sent by the server.
7767
7768hdr_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007769hdr_cnt(<header>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007770 Returns true when the number of occurrence of the specified header matches
7771 the values or ranges specified. It is important to remember that one header
7772 line may count as several headers if it has several values. This is used to
7773 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
7774 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
7775 of certain headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use
7776 the shdr_cnt() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7777
7778hdr_dir <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007779hdr_dir(<header>) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007780 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
7781 isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
7782 directory name matching, and may be used with Referer. See "hdr" for more
7783 information on header matching. Use the shdr_dir() variant for response
7784 headers sent by the server.
7785
7786hdr_dom <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007787hdr_dom(<header>) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007788 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
7789 isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name matching,
7790 and may be used with the Host header. See "hdr" for more information on
7791 header matching. Use the shdr_dom() variant for response headers sent by the
7792 server.
7793
7794hdr_end <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007795hdr_end(<header>) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007796 Returns true when one of the headers ends with one of the strings. See "hdr"
7797 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_end() variant for
7798 response headers sent by the server.
7799
7800hdr_ip <ip_address>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007801hdr_ip(<header>) <ip_address>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007802 Returns true when one of the headers' values contains an IP address matching
7803 <ip_address>. This is mainly used with headers such as X-Forwarded-For or
7804 X-Client-IP. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
7805 shdr_ip() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7806
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02007807hdr_len <integer>
7808hdr_len(<header>) <integer>
7809 Returns true when at least one of the headers has a length which matches the
7810 values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large
7811 headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
7812 shdr_len() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7813
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007814hdr_reg <regex>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007815hdr_reg(<header>) <regex>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007816 Returns true when one of the headers matches of the regular expressions. It
7817 can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching
7818 is slower than other methods. See also other "hdr_" criteria, as well as
7819 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_reg() variant for
7820 response headers sent by the server.
7821
7822hdr_sub <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007823hdr_sub(<header>) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007824 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings. See "hdr"
7825 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_sub() variant for
7826 response headers sent by the server.
7827
7828hdr_val <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007829hdr_val(<header>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007830 Returns true when one of the headers starts with a number which matches the
7831 values or ranges specified. This may be used to limit content-length to
7832 acceptable values for example. See "hdr" for more information on header
7833 matching. Use the shdr_val() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7834
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007835http_auth(<userlist>)
7836http_auth_group(<userlist>) <group> [<group>]*
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007837 Returns true when authentication data received from the client matches
7838 username & password stored on the userlist. It is also possible to
7839 use http_auth_group to check if the user is assigned to at least one
7840 of specified groups.
7841
7842 Currently only http basic auth is supported.
7843
Willy Tarreau85c27da2011-09-16 07:53:52 +02007844http_first_req
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +02007845 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
7846 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
7847 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or even to perform
7848 some specific ACL checks only on the first request.
7849
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007850method <string>
7851 Applies to the method in the HTTP request, eg: "GET". Some predefined ACL
7852 already check for most common methods.
7853
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007854path <string>
7855 Returns true when the path part of the request, which starts at the first
7856 slash and ends before the question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be
7857 used to match known files, such as /favicon.ico.
7858
7859path_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007860 Returns true when the path begins with one of the strings. This can be used
7861 to send certain directory names to alternative backends.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007862
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007863path_dir <string>
7864 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
7865 slashes in the path. This is used to perform filename or directory name
7866 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
7867 "url_dir" and "path_sub".
7868
7869path_dom <string>
7870 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
7871 in the path. This may be used to perform domain name matching in proxy
7872 requests. See also "path_sub" and "url_dom".
7873
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007874path_end <string>
7875 Returns true when the path ends with one of the strings. This may be used to
7876 control file name extension.
7877
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02007878path_len <integer>
7879 Returns true when the path length matches the values or ranges specified.
7880 This may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
7881
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007882path_reg <regex>
7883 Returns true when the path matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
7884 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
7885 than other methods. See also "url_reg" and all "path_" criteria.
7886
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007887path_sub <string>
7888 Returns true when the path contains one of the strings. It can be used to
7889 detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See also
7890 "path_dir".
7891
7892req_ver <string>
7893 Applies to the version string in the HTTP request, eg: "1.0". Some predefined
7894 ACL already check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
7895
7896status <integer>
7897 Applies to the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, eg: "302". It can be
7898 used to act on responses depending on status ranges, for instance, remove
7899 any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
7900
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007901url <string>
7902 Applies to the whole URL passed in the request. The only real use is to match
7903 "*", for which there already is a predefined ACL.
7904
7905url_beg <string>
7906 Returns true when the URL begins with one of the strings. This can be used to
7907 check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a protocol scheme.
7908
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007909url_dir <string>
7910 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
7911 slashes in the URL. This is used to perform filename or directory name
7912 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
7913 "path_dir" and "url_sub".
7914
7915url_dom <string>
7916 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
7917 in the URL. This is used to perform domain name matching without the risk of
7918 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "url_sub".
7919
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007920url_end <string>
7921 Returns true when the URL ends with one of the strings. It has very limited
7922 use. "path_end" should be used instead for filename matching.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007923
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01007924url_ip <ip_address>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007925 Applies to the IP address specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request.
7926 It can be used to prevent access to certain resources such as local network.
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007927 It is useful with option "http_proxy".
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01007928
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02007929url_len <integer>
7930 Returns true when the url length matches the values or ranges specified. This
7931 may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
7932
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01007933url_port <integer>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007934 Applies to the port specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request. It can
7935 be used to prevent access to certain resources. It is useful with option
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007936 "http_proxy". Note that if the port is not specified in the request, port 80
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007937 is assumed.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01007938
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007939url_reg <regex>
7940 Returns true when the URL matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
7941 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
7942 than other methods. See also "path_reg" and all "url_" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007943
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007944url_sub <string>
7945 Returns true when the URL contains one of the strings. It can be used to
7946 detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See also "path_sub".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007947
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007948
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079497.6. Pre-defined ACLs
7950---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007951
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007952Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
7953every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02007954order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007955
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007956ACL name Equivalent to Usage
7957---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007958FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007959HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007960HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
7961HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007962HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
7963HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
7964HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
7965HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
7966LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007967METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
7968METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
7969METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
7970METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
7971METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
7972METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007973RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007974REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007975TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007976WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
7977---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007978
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007979
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079807.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
7981----------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007982
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007983Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
7984combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007985
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007986 - AND (implicit)
7987 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
7988 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007989
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007990A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007991
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007992 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007993
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007994Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
7995indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007996
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007997For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
7998"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
7999requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
8000is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008001
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008002 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
8003 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
8004 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
8005 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008006
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008007To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
8008and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008009
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008010 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
8011 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
8012 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
8013 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008014
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008015 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
8016 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
8017 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
8018 use_backend www if host_www
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008019
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01008020It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
8021expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
8022be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
8023the braces must be seen as independant words). Example :
8024
8025 The following rule :
8026
8027 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
8028 block if METH_POST missing_cl
8029
8030 Can also be written that way :
8031
8032 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
8033
8034It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
8035to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
8036simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
8037sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
8038good use is the following :
8039
8040 With named ACLs :
8041
8042 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8043 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8044 monitor fail if site_dead
8045
8046 With anonymous ACLs :
8047
8048 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
8049
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008050See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008051
Willy Tarreau5764b382007-11-30 17:46:49 +01008052
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010080537.8. Pattern extraction
8054-----------------------
8055
8056The stickiness features relies on pattern extraction in the request and
8057response. Sometimes the data needs to be converted first before being stored,
8058for instance converted from ASCII to IP or upper case to lower case.
8059
8060All these operations of data extraction and conversion are defined as
8061"pattern extraction rules". A pattern rule always has the same format. It
8062begins with a single pattern fetch word, potentially followed by a list of
8063arguments within parenthesis then an optional list of transformations. As
8064much as possible, the pattern fetch functions use the same name as their
8065equivalent used in ACLs.
8066
8067The list of currently supported pattern fetch functions is the following :
8068
8069 src This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session.
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008070 It is of type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
8071 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
8072 according to RFC 4291.
8073
8074 src6 This is the source IPv6 address of the client of the session.
8075 It is of type IPv6 and only works with such tables.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008076
8077 dst This is the destination IPv4 address of the session on the
8078 client side, which is the address the client connected to.
8079 It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008080 type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
8081 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
8082 according to RFC 4291.
8083
8084 dst6 This is the destination IPv6 address of the session on the
8085 client side, which is the address the client connected to.
8086 It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008087 type IPv6 and only works with such tables.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008088
8089 dst_port This is the destination TCP port of the session on the client
8090 side, which is the port the client connected to. This might be
8091 used when running in transparent mode or when assigning dynamic
8092 ports to some clients for a whole application session. It is of
8093 type integer and only works with such tables.
8094
Willy Tarreaue428fb72011-12-16 21:50:30 +01008095 hdr(<name>) This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP
8096 request. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once
8097 converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreau4a568972010-05-12 08:08:50 +02008098
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008099 payload(<offset>,<length>)
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008100 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes, and starting
8101 at bytes <offset> in the buffer of request or response (request
8102 on "stick on" or "stick match" or response in on "stick store
8103 response").
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008104
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008105 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>])
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008106 This extracts a binary block. In a first step the size of the
8107 block is read from response or request buffer at <offset>
8108 bytes and considered coded on <length> bytes. In a second step
8109 data of the block are read from buffer at <offset2> bytes
8110 (by default <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize>).
8111 If <offset2> is prefixed by '+' or '-', it is relative to
8112 <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize> else it is absolute.
8113 Ex: see SSL session id example in "stick table" chapter.
8114
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008115 url_param(<name>)
David Cournapeau16023ee2010-12-23 20:55:41 +09008116 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008117 the query string of the request and uses the corresponding value
David Cournapeau16023ee2010-12-23 20:55:41 +09008118 to match. A typical use is to get sticky session through url (e.g.
8119 http://example.com/foo?JESSIONID=some_id with
8120 url_param(JSESSIONID)), for cases where cookies cannot be used.
8121
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008122 rdp_cookie(<name>)
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008123 This extracts the value of the rdp cookie <name> as a string
8124 and uses this value to match. This enables implementation of
8125 persistence based on the mstshash cookie. This is typically
8126 done if there is no msts cookie present.
8127
8128 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing
8129 algorithm may be used and thus the distribution of clients
8130 to backend servers is not linked to a hash of the RDP
8131 cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
8132 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconnect" will
8133 lead to a more even distribution of clients to backend
8134 servers than the hash used by "balance rdp-cookie".
8135
8136 Example :
8137 listen tse-farm
8138 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
8139 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
8140 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8141 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
8142 # apply RDP cookie persistence
8143 persist rdp-cookie
8144 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
8145 # This is only useful makes sense if
8146 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
8147 stick-table type string size 204800
8148 stick on rdp_cookie(mstshash)
8149 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
8150 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
8151
8152 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie",
8153 "tcp-request" and the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
8154
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008155 cookie(<name>)
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02008156 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
8157 "Cookie" header line from the request and uses the corresponding
8158 value to match. A typical use is to get multiple clients sharing
8159 a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
8160 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with
8161 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across
8162 restarts.
8163
8164 See also : "appsession"
8165
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008166 set-cookie(<name>)
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02008167 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
8168 "Set-Cookie" header line from the response and uses the
8169 corresponding value to match. This can be comparable to what
8170 "appsession" does with default options, but with support for
8171 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
8172
8173 See also : "appsession"
8174
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008175
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008176The currently available list of transformations include :
8177
8178 lower Convert a string pattern to lower case. This can only be placed
8179 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
8180 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
8181
8182 upper Convert a string pattern to upper case. This can only be placed
8183 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
8184 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
8185
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008186 ipmask(<mask>) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups
Willy Tarreaud31d6eb2010-01-26 18:01:41 +01008187 and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within a
8188 certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
8189 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
8190 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
8191
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008192
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020081938. Logging
8194----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008195
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008196One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
8197provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
8198very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
8199provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
8200state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008201to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008202headers.
8203
8204In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
8205about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
8206send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
8207
8208 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
8209 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
8210 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
8211 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
8212 at the termination.
8213
8214The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
8215allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
8216as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
8217while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
8218real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
8219delay.
8220
8221
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020082228.1. Log levels
8223---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008224
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008225TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008226source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008227HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
8228in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
8229track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
8230syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
8231about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008232
8233
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020082348.2. Log formats
8235----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008236
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008237HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008238and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
8239slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
8240options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008241
8242 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
8243 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
8244 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
8245 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
8246 extents.
8247
8248 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
8249 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
8250 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
8251 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
8252 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
8253
8254 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
8255 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
8256 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
8257 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
8258 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
8259
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008260 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
8261 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
8262 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
8263 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
8264
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008265 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
8266
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008267Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
8268specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
8269field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
8270servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
8271always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
8272identifier.
8273
8274Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
8275 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
8276 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
8277 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
8278 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
8279
8280
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020082818.2.1. Default log format
8282-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008283
8284This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
8285as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
8286format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
8287
8288 Example :
8289 listen www
8290 mode http
8291 log global
8292 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
8293
8294 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
8295 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
8296 (www/HTTP)
8297
8298 Field Format Extract from the example above
8299 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
8300 2 'Connect from' Connect from
8301 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
8302 4 'to' to
8303 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
8304 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
8305
8306Detailed fields description :
8307 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
8308 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
8309 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
8310 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
8311 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
8312 and processed the connection.
8313 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
8314
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008315In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
8316"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
8317connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
8318
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008319It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
8320will eventually disappear.
8321
8322
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020083238.2.2. TCP log format
8324---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008325
8326The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
8327is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
8328information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
8329counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
8330emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
8331environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
8332the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
8333sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008334specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
8335not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
8336fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
8337marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008338
8339 Example :
8340 frontend fnt
8341 mode tcp
8342 option tcplog
8343 log global
8344 default_backend bck
8345
8346 backend bck
8347 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
8348
8349 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
8350 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
8351 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
8352
8353 Field Format Extract from the example above
8354 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
8355 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
8356 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
8357 4 frontend_name fnt
8358 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
8359 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
8360 7 bytes_read* 212
8361 8 termination_state --
8362 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
8363 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
8364
8365Detailed fields description :
8366 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008367 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
8368 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
8369 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
8370 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
8371 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008372
8373 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008374 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
8375 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
8376 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008377
8378 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
8379 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
8380 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
8381 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
8382
8383 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
8384 and processed the connection.
8385
8386 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
8387 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
8388 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
8389 applications.
8390
8391 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
8392 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
8393 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
8394 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
8395 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
8396
8397 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
8398 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
8399 See "Timers" below for more details.
8400
8401 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
8402 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
8403 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
8404 "Timers" below for more details.
8405
8406 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
8407 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
8408 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
8409 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
8410 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
8411 details.
8412
8413 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
8414 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
8415 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
8416 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
8417 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
8418
8419 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
8420 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
8421 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
8422 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
8423 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
8424 for more details.
8425
8426 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
8427 the session was logged. It it useful to detect when some per-process system
8428 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
8429 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
8430 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008431 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008432
8433 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
8434 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
8435 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
8436 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
8437 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
8438 caused by a denial of service attack.
8439
8440 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
8441 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
8442 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
8443 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
8444 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
8445 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
8446 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
8447 denial of service attack.
8448
8449 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
8450 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
8451 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
8452 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
8453 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
8454 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
8455 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
8456 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
8457 be processed than on other servers.
8458
8459 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
8460 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
8461 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
8462 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
8463 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
8464 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
8465 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
8466 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
8467 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
8468 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
8469 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
8470 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
8471 should not be attributed to the logged server.
8472
8473 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8474 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
8475 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
8476 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
8477 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
8478 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
8479 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
8480 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
8481
8482 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8483 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
8484 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
8485 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
8486 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
8487 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
8488 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
8489 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
8490 occurs.
8491
8492
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020084938.2.3. HTTP log format
8494----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008495
8496The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
8497is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
8498the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
8499are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
8500emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
8501generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
8502"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
8503which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008504frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
8505is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008506
8507Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
8508slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
8509with a star ('*') after the field name below.
8510
8511 Example :
8512 frontend http-in
8513 mode http
8514 option httplog
8515 log global
8516 default_backend bck
8517
8518 backend static
8519 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
8520
8521 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
8522 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
8523 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008524 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008525
8526 Field Format Extract from the example above
8527 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
8528 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
8529 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
8530 4 frontend_name http-in
8531 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
8532 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
8533 7 status_code 200
8534 8 bytes_read* 2750
8535 9 captured_request_cookie -
8536 10 captured_response_cookie -
8537 11 termination_state ----
8538 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
8539 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
8540 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
8541 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
8542 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008543
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008544
8545Detailed fields description :
8546 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008547 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
8548 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
8549 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
8550 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
8551 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008552
8553 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008554 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
8555 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
8556 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008557
8558 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
8559 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
8560 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
8561 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
8562 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
8563
8564 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
8565 and processed the connection.
8566
8567 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
8568 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
8569 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
8570
8571 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
8572 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
8573 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
8574 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
8575 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
8576 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
8577
8578 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
8579 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
8580 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
8581 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
8582 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
8583 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
8584
8585 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
8586 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
8587 See "Timers" below for more details.
8588
8589 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
8590 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
8591 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
8592 below for more details.
8593
8594 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
8595 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
8596 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
8597 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
8598 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
8599 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
8600 for more details.
8601
8602 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
8603 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
8604 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
8605 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
8606 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
8607 details.
8608
8609 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
8610 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
8611 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
8612
8613 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
8614 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
8615 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
8616 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
8617 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
8618 overflowing.
8619
8620 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
8621 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
8622 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
8623 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
8624 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
8625 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
8626 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
8627 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
8628
8629 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
8630 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
8631 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
8632 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
8633 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
8634 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
8635 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
8636 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
8637
8638 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
8639 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
8640 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
8641 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
8642 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
8643 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
8644 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
8645
8646 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
8647 the session was logged. It it useful to detect when some per-process system
8648 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
8649 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
8650 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008651 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008652 system.
8653
8654 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
8655 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
8656 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
8657 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
8658 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
8659 caused by a denial of service attack.
8660
8661 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
8662 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
8663 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
8664 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
8665 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
8666 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
8667 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
8668 denial of service attack.
8669
8670 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
8671 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
8672 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
8673 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
8674 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
8675 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
8676 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
8677 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
8678 processed than on other servers.
8679
8680 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
8681 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
8682 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
8683 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
8684 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
8685 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
8686 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
8687 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
8688 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
8689 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
8690 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
8691 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
8692 should not be attributed to the logged server.
8693
8694 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8695 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
8696 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
8697 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
8698 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
8699 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
8700 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
8701 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
8702
8703 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8704 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
8705 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
8706 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
8707 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
8708 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
8709 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
8710 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
8711 occurs.
8712
8713 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
8714 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
8715 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
8716 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
8717 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
8718 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
8719 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
8720 cookies" below for more details.
8721
8722 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
8723 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
8724 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
8725 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
8726 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
8727 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
8728 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
8729 and cookies" below for more details.
8730
8731 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
8732 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
8733 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
8734 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
8735 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
8736 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
8737 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
8738 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
8739
8740
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010087418.2.4 Custom log format
8742-----------------------
8743
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01008744The directive log-format allows you to custom the logs in http mode and tcp
8745mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008746
8747HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
8748Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
8749separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
8750prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
8751
8752Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
8753variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
8754string formats ("Q").
8755
8756Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
8757HAproxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
8758
8759Flags are :
8760 * Q: quote a string
8761
8762 Example:
8763
8764 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
8765 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
8766
8767At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
8768
8769 log-format %Ci:%Cp\ [%t]\ %f\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %st\ %B\ %cc\ \
Willy Tarreau6580c062012-03-12 15:09:42 +01008770 %cs\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008771
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01008772the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008773
8774 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}Ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %st\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %Cp\ \
Willy Tarreau6580c062012-03-12 15:09:42 +01008775 %ms\ %f\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008776 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %cc\ %cs\ \%hrl\ %hsl
8777
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01008778and the default TCP format is defined this way :
8779
8780 log-format %Ci:%Cp\ [%t]\ %f\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
8781 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
8782
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008783Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
8784
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01008785 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
8786 | H | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
8787 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
8788 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
8789 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
8790 | | %B | bytes_read | numeric |
8791 | | %Ci | client_ip | string |
8792 | | %Cp | client_port | numeric |
William Lallemandb7ff6a32012-03-02 14:35:21 +01008793 | | %Bi | backend_source_ip | string |
8794 | | %Bp | backend_source_port | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01008795 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
8796 | * | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
8797 | * | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
8798 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
8799 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
8800 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
8801 | | %b | backend_name | string |
8802 | | %bc | beconn | numeric |
8803 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
8804 | * | %cc | captured_request_cookie | string |
8805 | * | %cs | captured_response_cookie | string |
8806 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
8807 | | %fc | feconn | numeric |
8808 | * | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
8809 | * | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
8810 | * | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
8811 | * | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
8812 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
8813 | * | %r | http_request | string |
8814 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
8815 | | %s | server_name | string |
8816 | | %sc | srv_conn | numeric |
8817 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
8818 | * | %st | status_code | numeric |
8819 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreau6580c062012-03-12 15:09:42 +01008820 | * | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01008821 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008822
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01008823*: mode httplog only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008824
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020088258.3. Advanced logging options
8826-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008827
8828Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
8829just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
8830options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
8831for more information about their usage.
8832
8833
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020088348.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
8835------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008836
8837It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
8838haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
8839commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
8840monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
8841ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
8842
8843 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
8844 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
8845 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
8846 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
8847
8848 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
8849 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
8850 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
8851 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments
8852 such as other load-balancers.
8853
8854 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
8855 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
8856 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
8857
8858
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020088598.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
8860----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008861
8862The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
8863what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
8864or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
8865"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
8866just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
8867log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
8868after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
8869is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
8870with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
8871with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
8872
8873
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020088748.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
8875------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008876
8877Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
8878for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
8879"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
8880retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
8881raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
8882a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
8883file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
8884you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
8885"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
8886
8887
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020088888.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
8889--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008890
8891Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
8892multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
8893them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
8894"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
8895logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
8896error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
8897and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
8898too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
8899useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
8900alternative.
8901
8902
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020089038.4. Timing events
8904------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008905
8906Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
8907reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
8908the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
8909frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
8910mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
8911
8912 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
8913 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
8914 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
8915 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
8916 the client closes prematurely or times out.
8917
8918 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
8919 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
8920 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
8921 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
8922 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
8923
8924 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
8925 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
8926 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
8927 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
8928 connection never established.
8929
8930 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
8931 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
8932 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
8933 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
8934 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
8935 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
8936 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
8937 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
8938 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
8939 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
8940 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
8941
8942 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
8943 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
8944 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
8945 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
8946 transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid :
8947
8948 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
8949
8950 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
8951 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
8952 negative.
8953
8954These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
8955protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
8956that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008957due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008958close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
8959session has been aborted on timeout.
8960
8961Most common cases :
8962
8963 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
8964 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
8965 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
8966 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
8967 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
8968 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
8969 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
8970 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
8971 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +02008972 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
8973 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
8974 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008975
8976 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
8977 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
8978 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
8979 of ms on remote networks.
8980
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008981 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
8982 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
8983 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008984
8985 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
8986 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
8987 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
8988 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
8989 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
8990 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
8991 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
8992 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
8993 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
8994 to the server until another one is released.
8995
8996Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
8997
8998 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
8999 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
9000 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
9001
9002 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
9003 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
9004 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
9005
9006 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
9007 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
9008 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
9009 flags.
9010
9011 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
9012 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
9013 Check the session termination flags, then check the
9014 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
9015 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
9016 the client connection was maintained open.
9017
9018 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
9019 a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion
9020 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
9021 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
9022
9023
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020090248.5. Session state at disconnection
9025-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009026
9027TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
9028"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
90292-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
9030each of which has a special meaning :
9031
9032 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
9033 session to terminate :
9034
9035 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
9036
9037 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
9038 server explicitly refused it.
9039
9040 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
9041 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
9042 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
9043 error in server response which might have caused information leak
9044 (eg: cacheable cookie), or because the response was processed by
9045 the proxy (redirect, stats, etc...).
9046
9047 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
9048 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
9049 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
9050 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
9051 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
9052
9053 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
9054 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
9055 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
9056 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
9057 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
9058
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +09009059 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
9060 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
9061
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +02009062 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
9063
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009064 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
9065 send or receive data.
9066
9067 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
9068 send or receive data.
9069
9070 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
9071 with nothing left in the buffers.
9072
9073 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
9074
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01009075 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009076 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
9077
9078 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
9079 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
9080 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
9081 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
9082 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
9083
9084 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
9085 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
9086
9087 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
9088 server (HTTP only).
9089
9090 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
9091
9092 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
9093 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
9094 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
9095
9096 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
9097 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
9098 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
9099
9100 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
9101
9102 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
9103 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
9104
9105 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
9106 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
9107 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
9108
9109 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
9110 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02009111 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
9112 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009113
9114 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
9115 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
9116 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
9117 another server.
9118
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009119 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009120 server.
9121
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009122 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
9123 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
9124 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
9125 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
9126
9127 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
9128 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
9129 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
9130 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
9131
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009132 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
9133
9134 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
9135 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
9136
9137 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
9138
9139 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
9140 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
9141 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
9142
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009143 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
9144 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
9145 happens everytime there is activity at a different date than the
9146 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
9147 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
9148
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009149 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
9150
9151 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
9152 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
9153
9154 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
9155
9156 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
9157
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009158The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
9159was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009160helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
9161starvation, attacks, etc...
9162
9163The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
9164alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
9165easier finding and understanding.
9166
9167 Flags Reason
9168
9169 -- Normal termination.
9170
9171 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
9172 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
9173 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
9174 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
9175
9176 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
9177 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
9178 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
9179 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
9180 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
9181 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009182
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009183 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
9184 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
9185 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
9186
9187 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
9188 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
9189 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
9190
9191 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
9192 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
9193 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
9194 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
9195 the server takes too long to respond.
9196
9197 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
9198 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
9199 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
9200 long a time to respond.
9201
9202 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
9203 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
9204 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
9205 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
9206 and the client.
9207
9208 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
9209 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
9210 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
9211 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
9212 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
9213 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
9214
9215 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
9216 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009217 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
9218 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
9219 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
9220 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009221
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009222 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009223 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
9224 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
9225 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
9226 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
9227 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
9228
9229 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
9230 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
9231 503 or 504 here.
9232
9233 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
9234 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
9235 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
9236 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
9237 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
9238
9239 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
9240 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009241 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009242 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
9243 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
9244
9245 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
9246 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
9247 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
9248 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
9249 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
9250 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
9251 between haproxy and the server.
9252
9253 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
9254 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
9255 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
9256 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
9257 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
9258 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
9259 solution is to fix the application.
9260
9261 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
9262 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
9263 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
9264 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
9265 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
9266 external attacks.
9267
9268 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
9269 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
9270 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
9271 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
9272 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
9273
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +01009274 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
9275 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
9276 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
9277 the client.
9278
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009279 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
9280 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
9281 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
9282 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +01009283 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
9284 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
9285 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
9286 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
9287 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009288
9289 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
9290 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
9291 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
9292 returned an HTTP 403 error.
9293
9294 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
9295 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
9296 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
9297 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
9298
9299 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
9300 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
9301 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
9302 only be solved by proper system tuning.
9303
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009304The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
9305persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
9306important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
9307re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
9308
9309 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
9310
9311 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
9312 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
9313 set on a GET request.
9314
9315 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
9316 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
9317 a "server" entry is removed from the configuraton, since its cookie
9318 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
9319
9320 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
9321 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
9322 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
9323
9324 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
9325 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
9326 already got a cookie.
9327
9328 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
9329 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
9330 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
9331 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
9332 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
9333
9334 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
9335 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
9336 new cookie was inserted in the response.
9337
9338 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
9339 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
9340 new cookie was inserted in the response.
9341
9342 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
9343 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
9344
9345 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
9346 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
9347 then advertised in the response.
9348
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009349
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020093508.6. Non-printable characters
9351-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009352
9353In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
9354consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
9355converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
9356prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
9357being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
9358escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
9359is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
9360'}' when logging headers.
9361
9362Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
9363issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
9364containing spaces is "User-Agent".
9365
9366Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
9367the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
9368performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
9369
9370
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020093718.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
9372---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009373
9374Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
9375achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009376section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009377cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
9378the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
9379the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009380locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009381not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
9382user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
9383a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
9384wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
9385
9386 Examples :
9387 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
9388 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
9389
9390 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
9391 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
9392
9393
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020093948.8. Capturing HTTP headers
9395---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009396
9397Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
9398proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
9399the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
9400server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
9401
9402Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
9403response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009404section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009405
9406It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009407time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
9408appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009409are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
9410and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
9411follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
9412request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
9413in the logs.
9414
9415 Example :
9416 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
9417 listen proxy-out
9418 mode http
9419 option httplog
9420 option logasap
9421 log global
9422 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
9423
9424 # log the name of the virtual server
9425 capture request header Host len 20
9426
9427 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
9428 capture request header Content-Length len 10
9429
9430 # log the beginning of the referrer
9431 capture request header Referer len 20
9432
9433 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
9434 capture response header Server len 20
9435
9436 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
9437 capture response header Content-Length len 10
9438
9439 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
9440 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
9441
9442 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
9443 capture response header Via len 20
9444
9445 # log the URL location during a redirection
9446 capture response header Location len 20
9447
9448 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
9449 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
9450 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
9451 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
9452 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
9453
9454 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
9455 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
9456 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
9457 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009458 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009459
9460 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
9461 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
9462 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
9463 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
9464 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009465 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009466
9467
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020094688.9. Examples of logs
9469---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009470
9471These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
9472them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
9473reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
9474
9475 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
9476 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
9477 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
9478
9479 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
9480 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
9481
9482 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
9483 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
9484 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
9485
9486 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
9487 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
9488
9489 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
9490 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
9491 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9492
9493 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009494 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009495 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
9496 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
9497
9498 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
9499 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
9500 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
9501
9502 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
9503 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02009504 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009505 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
9506 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
9507 to return the 502 and not the server.
9508
9509 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009510 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009511
9512 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
9513 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
9514 Nothing was sent to any server.
9515
9516 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
9517 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
9518
9519 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
9520 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
9521 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
9522 send a 408 return code to the client.
9523
9524 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
9525 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
9526
9527 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
9528 5 seconds ("c----").
9529
9530 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
9531 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009532 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009533
9534 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009535 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009536 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
9537 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
9538 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
9539 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
9540 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009541
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009542
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095439. Statistics and monitoring
9544----------------------------
9545
9546It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
9547mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
9548CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
9549Unix socket.
9550
9551
95529.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009553---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009554
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +01009555The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
9556page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
9557
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009558 0. pxname: proxy name
9559 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
9560 for server)
9561 2. qcur: current queued requests
9562 3. qmax: max queued requests
9563 4. scur: current sessions
9564 5. smax: max sessions
9565 6. slim: sessions limit
9566 7. stot: total sessions
9567 8. bin: bytes in
9568 9. bout: bytes out
9569 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009570 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009571 12. ereq: request errors
9572 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +01009573 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009574 15. wretr: retries (warning)
9575 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +01009576 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009577 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
9578 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
9579 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
9580 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
9581 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
9582 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
9583 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
9584 25. qlimit: queue limit
9585 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
9586 27. iid: unique proxy id
9587 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
9588 29. throttle: warm up status
9589 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
9590 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009591 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +02009592 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
9593 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
9594 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +02009595 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01009596 UNK -> unknown
9597 INI -> initializing
9598 SOCKERR -> socket error
9599 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
9600 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
9601 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
9602 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
9603 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
9604 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
9605 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
9606 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
9607 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
9608 disable-on-404
9609 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
9610 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
9611 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +02009612 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
9613 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009614 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
9615 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
9616 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
9617 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
9618 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
9619 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009620 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
9621 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
9622 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
9623 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +01009624 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
9625 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009626
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009627
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020096289.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009629-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009630
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009631The following commands are supported on the UNIX stats socket ; all of them
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009632must be terminated by a line feed. The socket supports pipelining, so that it
9633is possible to chain multiple commands at once provided they are delimited by
9634a semi-colon or a line feed, although the former is more reliable as it has no
9635risk of being truncated over the network. The responses themselves will each be
9636followed by an empty line, so it will be easy for an external script to match a
9637given response with a given request. By default one command line is processed
9638then the connection closes, but there is an interactive allowing multiple lines
9639to be issued one at a time.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009640
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009641It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
9642on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
9643own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009644
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009645clear counters
9646 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
9647 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
9648 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
9649 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
9650 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
9651
9652clear counters all
9653 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
9654 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
9655 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
9656
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +09009657clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
9658 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
9659
9660 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
9661 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
9662 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
9663 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
9664 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
9665 later after the session ends is usual enough.
9666
9667 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
9668
9669 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
9670 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
9671 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
9672 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
9673 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
9674 the ACLs :
9675
9676 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
9677 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
9678 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
9679 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
9680 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
9681 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
9682
9683 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +09009684 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
9685 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009686
9687 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009688 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009689 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009690 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
9691 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
9692 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9693 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009694
9695 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9696
9697 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009698 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009699 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9700 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +09009701 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9702 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9703 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009704
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +02009705disable frontend <frontend>
9706 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
9707 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
9708 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
9709 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
9710 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
9711 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
9712 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
9713 on the stats page.
9714
9715 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
9716 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
9717
9718 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
9719 level "admin".
9720
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009721disable server <backend>/<server>
9722 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
9723 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
9724 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
9725 during the maintenance.
9726
9727 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
9728 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
9729
9730 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +02009731 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009732
9733 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
9734 level "admin".
9735
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +02009736enable frontend <frontend>
9737 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
9738 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
9739 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
9740 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
9741 which was disabled.
9742
9743 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
9744 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
9745
9746 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
9747 level "admin".
9748
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009749enable server <backend>/<server>
9750 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
9751 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
9752
9753 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +02009754 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009755
9756 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
9757 level "admin".
9758
9759get weight <backend>/<server>
9760 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
9761 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
9762 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
9763 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
9764 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +02009765 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009766
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009767help
9768 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
9769 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009770
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009771prompt
9772 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
9773 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
9774 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
9775 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
9776 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
9777 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
9778 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
9779 command.
9780
9781quit
9782 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009783
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +02009784set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
9785 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any non-null
9786 positive value is allowed, but setting values larger than the global maxconn
9787 does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections were
9788 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
9789 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
9790 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
9791 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
9792
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +02009793set maxconn global <maxconn>
9794 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
9795 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
9796 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
9797 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
9798 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
9799 setting.
9800
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +02009801set rate-limit connections global <value>
9802 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
9803 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
9804 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
9805 is passed in number of connections per second.
9806
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009807set timeout cli <delay>
9808 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
9809 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
9810 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
9811
9812set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
9813 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
9814 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
9815 configured weight. Relative weights are only permitted between 0 and 100%,
9816 and absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256. Servers which are part
9817 of a farm running a static load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations
9818 because the weight cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only
9819 accepted values are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take
9820 effect immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
9821 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to disable
9822 a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to enable it
9823 again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command is restricted
9824 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin". Both the
9825 backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by their
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +02009826 numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009827
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01009828show errors [<iid>]
9829 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
9830 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02009831 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
9832 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
9833 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01009834
9835 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
9836 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
9837 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
9838 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
9839 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
9840 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
9841 are reported too.
9842
9843 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
9844 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
9845 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
9846 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
9847 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
9848 code.
9849
9850 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
9851 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
9852 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
9853 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
9854 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
9855 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
9856 line.
9857
9858 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009859 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9860 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01009861 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
9862 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
9863
9864 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
9865 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
9866 00038 Location: blah\r\n
9867 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
9868 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
9869 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
9870 00204+ minal\r\n
9871 00211 \r\n
9872
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009873 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01009874 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
9875 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
9876 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
9877 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
9878 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
9879 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009880
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009881show info
9882 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
9883
9884show sess
9885 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02009886 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
9887 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
9888
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +01009889show sess <id>
9890 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
9891 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
9892 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
9893 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
9894 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
9895 freely evolve depending on demands.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009896
9897show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
9898 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
9899 possible to dump only selected items :
9900 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
9901 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
9902 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
9903 for example:
9904 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
9905 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
9906 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
9907
9908 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009909 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
9910 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009911 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
9912 Release_date: 2009/09/23
9913 Nbproc: 1
9914 Process_num: 1
9915 (...)
9916
9917 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
9918 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
9919 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
9920 (...)
9921 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
9922
9923 $
9924
9925 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
9926 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
9927 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
9928 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009929 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009930
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009931show table
9932 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
9933 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
9934 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
9935 entries currently in use.
9936
9937 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009938 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +09009939 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
9940 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009941
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +09009942show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009943 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
9944 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
9945 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +09009946 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
9947
9948 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
9949 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
9950 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
9951 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
9952 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
9953
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009954 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
9955 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
9956 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
9957 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
9958 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
9959 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
9960
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +09009961
9962 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +09009963 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
9964 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +09009965
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009966 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009967 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +09009968 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009969 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
9970 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
9971 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9972 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009973
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009974 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +09009975 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009976 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9977 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009978
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009979 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
9980 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +09009981 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009982 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9983 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009984
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +09009985 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
9986 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +09009987 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +09009988 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9989 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
9990
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009991 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
9992 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
9993 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
9994 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
9995 time goes, the average event rate drops.
9996
9997 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
9998 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
9999 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010000 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
10001 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010002 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
10003 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020010004
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020010005shutdown frontend <frontend>
10006 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
10007 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
10008 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
10009 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
10010 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
10011 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
10012 once it is terminated.
10013
10014 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
10015 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
10016
10017 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10018 level "admin".
10019
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020010020shutdown session <id>
10021 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
10022 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
10023 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
10024 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
10025 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
10026 flag in the logs.
10027
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020010028shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
10029 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
10030 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
10031 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
10032 'K' flag in the logs.
10033
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010034/*
10035 * Local variables:
10036 * fill-column: 79
10037 * End:
10038 */